x86: Propery check PC16 reloc overflow in 16-bit mode instructions
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
CommitLineData
252b5132
RH
1\input texinfo
2@setfilename ld.info
250d07de 3@c Copyright (C) 1991-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 4@syncodeindex ky cp
dff70155 5@c man begin INCLUDE
252b5132
RH
6@include configdoc.texi
7@c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
c428fa83 8@include bfdver.texi
dff70155 9@c man end
252b5132
RH
10
11@c @smallbook
12
ff5dcc92
SC
13@macro gcctabopt{body}
14@code{\body\}
15@end macro
16
0285c67d
NC
17@c man begin NAME
18@ifset man
19@c Configure for the generation of man pages
20@set UsesEnvVars
21@set GENERIC
0285c67d 22@set ARM
ac145307 23@set C6X
b8891f8d 24@set CSKY
49fa1e15 25@set H8300
0285c67d 26@set HPPA
0285c67d 27@set M68HC11
7fb9f789 28@set M68K
833794fc 29@set MIPS
3c3bdf30 30@set MMIX
2469cfa2 31@set MSP430
35c08157 32@set NDS32
78058a5e 33@set NIOSII
fa1477dc 34@set PDP11
2a60a7a8
AM
35@set POWERPC
36@set POWERPC64
49fa1e15 37@set Renesas
b4cbbe8f 38@set S/390
49fa1e15
AM
39@set SPU
40@set TICOFF
2ca22b03 41@set WIN32
e0001a05 42@set XTENSA
0285c67d
NC
43@end ifset
44@c man end
45
9160ea82
AM
46@ifnottex
47@dircategory Software development
48@direntry
252b5132 49* Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
9160ea82
AM
50@end direntry
51@end ifnottex
252b5132 52
0e9517a9 53@copying
e49e529d
JM
54This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57@end ifset
58version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 59
250d07de 60Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 61
cf055d54 62Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 63under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
cf055d54
NC
64or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 67section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0e9517a9 68@end copying
252b5132
RH
69@iftex
70@finalout
71@setchapternewpage odd
71ba23f6 72@settitle The GNU linker
252b5132 73@titlepage
71ba23f6 74@title The GNU linker
252b5132 75@sp 1
e49e529d
JM
76@subtitle @code{ld}
77@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79@end ifset
252b5132
RH
80@subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81@author Steve Chamberlain
82@author Ian Lance Taylor
252b5132
RH
83@page
84
85@tex
86{\parskip=0pt
704c465c
NC
87\hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88\hfill nickc\@credhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
71ba23f6 89\hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
252b5132
RH
90\hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91}
92\global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93@end tex
94
95@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
0285c67d 96@c man begin COPYRIGHT
250d07de 97Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 98
0285c67d 99Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 100under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
0285c67d
NC
101or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 104section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0285c67d 105@c man end
252b5132 106
252b5132
RH
107@end titlepage
108@end iftex
4ecceb71 109@contents
252b5132
RH
110@c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
84ec0e6d 112@ifnottex
252b5132 113@node Top
71ba23f6 114@top LD
e49e529d
JM
115This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118@end ifset
119version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 120
cf055d54 121This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
793c5807
NC
122Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
cf055d54 124
252b5132
RH
125@menu
126* Overview:: Overview
127* Invocation:: Invocation
128* Scripts:: Linker Scripts
bf6d8037 129* Plugins:: Linker Plugins
252b5132
RH
130@ifset GENERIC
131* Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
132@end ifset
133@ifclear GENERIC
134@ifset H8300
135* H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
136@end ifset
c2dcd04e
NC
137@ifset Renesas
138* Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
252b5132 139@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
140@ifset ARM
141* ARM:: ld and the ARM family
142@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
143@ifset M68HC11
144* M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
145@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
146@ifset HPPA
147* HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
148@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
149@ifset M68K
150* M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
151@end ifset
833794fc
MR
152@ifset MIPS
153* MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
154@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
155@ifset POWERPC
156* PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
157@end ifset
158@ifset POWERPC64
159* PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
160@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
161@ifset S/390
162* S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
163@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
164@ifset SPU
165* SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
166@end ifset
74459f0e
TW
167@ifset TICOFF
168* TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
169@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
170@ifset WIN32
171* Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
172@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
173@ifset XTENSA
174* Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
175@end ifset
252b5132
RH
176@end ifclear
177@ifclear SingleFormat
178* BFD:: BFD
179@end ifclear
180@c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
181
182* Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
183* MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
704c465c 184* GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
370b66a1 185* LD Index:: LD Index
252b5132 186@end menu
84ec0e6d 187@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
188
189@node Overview
190@chapter Overview
191
192@cindex @sc{gnu} linker
193@cindex what is this?
0285c67d 194
0879a67a 195@ifset man
0285c67d 196@c man begin SYNOPSIS
ff5dcc92 197ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
0285c67d
NC
198@c man end
199
200@c man begin SEEALSO
201ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
202the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
203@file{ld}.
204@c man end
205@end ifset
206
207@c man begin DESCRIPTION
208
ff5dcc92 209@command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
252b5132 210their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
ff5dcc92 211compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
252b5132 212
ff5dcc92 213@command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
252b5132
RH
214a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
215to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
216
0285c67d
NC
217@ifset man
218@c For the man only
ece2d90e 219This man page does not describe the command language; see the
71ba23f6
NC
220@command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
221language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
0285c67d
NC
222@end ifset
223
252b5132 224@ifclear SingleFormat
ff5dcc92
SC
225This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
226to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
252b5132
RH
227write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
228@code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
229available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
230@end ifclear
231
232Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
233linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
234execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
ff5dcc92 235@command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
252b5132
RH
236(or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
237
0285c67d
NC
238@c man end
239
252b5132
RH
240@node Invocation
241@chapter Invocation
242
0285c67d
NC
243@c man begin DESCRIPTION
244
ff5dcc92 245The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
252b5132
RH
246and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
247you have many choices to control its behavior.
248
0285c67d
NC
249@c man end
250
252b5132
RH
251@ifset UsesEnvVars
252@menu
a05a5b64 253* Options:: Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
254* Environment:: Environment Variables
255@end menu
256
257@node Options
a05a5b64 258@section Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
259@end ifset
260
261@cindex command line
262@cindex options
0285c67d
NC
263
264@c man begin OPTIONS
265
252b5132
RH
266The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
267practice few of them are used in any particular context.
268@cindex standard Unix system
ff5dcc92 269For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
252b5132
RH
270object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
271link a file @code{hello.o}:
272
273@smallexample
274ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
275@end smallexample
276
ff5dcc92 277This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
252b5132
RH
278result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
279the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
280directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
281
ff5dcc92 282Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
511ab9e9
ILT
283point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
284as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
285which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
286files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
287different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
252b5132
RH
288occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
289option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
290noted in the descriptions below.
291
292@cindex object files
511ab9e9
ILT
293Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
294together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
295options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
296an option and its argument.
252b5132
RH
297
298Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
299specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
300and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
301are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
302message @samp{No input files}.
303
36f63dca 304If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
252b5132
RH
305assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
306augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
307linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
308permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
309or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
53d25da6
AM
310@code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
311script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
312extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
313to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
314the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
252b5132
RH
315
316For options whose names are a single letter,
317option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
318whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
319option that requires them.
320
321For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
e4897a32 322precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
36f63dca 323@samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
e4897a32 324this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
ba1be17e 325only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
e4897a32
NC
326@samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
327name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
328output.
329
330Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
331option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
332immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
333@samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
334Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
335accepted.
252b5132 336
36f63dca 337Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
a05a5b64 338(e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
fa19fce0
NC
339prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
340compiler driver) like this:
4e53152f
NC
341
342@smallexample
2509a395 343 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
4e53152f
NC
344@end smallexample
345
346This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
2509a395
SL
347silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
348may also arise when passing options that require values through a
349driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
350a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
351and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
352the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
353
354@smallexample
355 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
356@end smallexample
4e53152f 357
a05a5b64 358Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
4e53152f
NC
359linker:
360
ff5dcc92 361@table @gcctabopt
38fc1cb1 362@include at-file.texi
dff70155 363
2509a395
SL
364@kindex -a @var{keyword}
365@item -a @var{keyword}
252b5132
RH
366This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
367argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
368@samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
369@samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
370to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
371
7ee314fa
AM
372@kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373@item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
374Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
375@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
376specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
377will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
378finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
9d5777a3 379it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
7ee314fa 380This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
9d5777a3 381interface.
7ee314fa 382
252b5132
RH
383@ifclear SingleFormat
384@cindex binary input format
385@kindex -b @var{format}
386@kindex --format=@var{format}
387@cindex input format
388@cindex input format
389@item -b @var{input-format}
390@itemx --format=@var{input-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
391@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
392file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 393@samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
ff5dcc92 394that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
252b5132 395configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
ff5dcc92 396to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
252b5132
RH
397default input format the most usual format on each machine.
398@var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
399supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
400formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
401@xref{BFD}.
402
403You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
404binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
405linking object files of different formats), by including
406@samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
a1ab1d2a 407particular format.
252b5132
RH
408
409The default format is taken from the environment variable
410@code{GNUTARGET}.
411@ifset UsesEnvVars
412@xref{Environment}.
413@end ifset
414You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
0285c67d
NC
415@code{TARGET};
416@ifclear man
417see @ref{Format Commands}.
418@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
419@end ifclear
420
421@kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
422@kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
423@cindex compatibility, MRI
424@item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
425@itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
ff5dcc92 426For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
252b5132 427files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
0285c67d
NC
428@ifclear man
429@ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
430@end ifclear
431@ifset man
432the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
433@end ifset
434Introduce MRI script files with
252b5132 435the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
ff5dcc92
SC
436scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
437If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
252b5132
RH
438specified by any @samp{-L} options.
439
440@cindex common allocation
441@kindex -d
442@kindex -dc
443@kindex -dp
a1ab1d2a 444@item -d
252b5132
RH
445@itemx -dc
446@itemx -dp
447These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
448compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
449even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
450script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
451@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
452
7ee314fa
AM
453@kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
454@kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
455@item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
456@itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
457Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
458@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
459specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
460will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
461option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
9d5777a3 462The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
7ee314fa 463
abf874aa
CL
464@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
466This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
467fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
468section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
469error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
470several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
471section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
472sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
473
474@smallexample
475 MEMORY @{
476 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
477 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
478 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
479 @}
480 SECTIONS @{
481 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
482 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
484 @}
485
486 with input sections:
487 .data.1: size 8
488 .data.2: size 0x10
489 .data.3: size 4
490
491 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
492 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
493@end smallexample
494
495This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
496the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
497
498@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
500This option enables warnings when
501@code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
502matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
503discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
504output region.
505
252b5132
RH
506@cindex entry point, from command line
507@kindex -e @var{entry}
508@kindex --entry=@var{entry}
a1ab1d2a 509@item -e @var{entry}
252b5132
RH
510@itemx --entry=@var{entry}
511Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
512program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
513named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
514and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
515base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
516@samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
517and other ways of specifying the entry point.
518
b58f81ae
DJ
519@kindex --exclude-libs
520@item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
521Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
e1c37eb5 522exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
b58f81ae
DJ
523@code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
524automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
525port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
526explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
527option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
528be treated as hidden.
529
e1c37eb5
DK
530@kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
531@item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
532Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
533should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
534into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
535may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
536used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
537the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
538match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
539command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
540of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
541regardless of this option.
542
252b5132
RH
543@cindex dynamic symbol table
544@kindex -E
545@kindex --export-dynamic
267e2722 546@kindex --no-export-dynamic
252b5132
RH
547@item -E
548@itemx --export-dynamic
267e2722
CD
549@itemx --no-export-dynamic
550When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
551option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
552all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
553set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
554
555If you do not use either of these options (or use the
556@option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
557dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
558referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
252b5132
RH
559
560If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
561back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
562dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
563linking the program itself.
564
55255dae 565You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
cb840a31 566be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
55255dae 567See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
cb840a31 568
8b747e1a
DK
569Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
570support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
571the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
572
37a141bf
FS
573@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
574@cindex export dynamic symbol
575@item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
576When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
577@var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
578shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
579bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
580no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
581@samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
582on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
583
584@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
585@cindex export dynamic symbol list
586@item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
587Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
588The format of the file is the same as the version node without
589scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
590
36f63dca 591@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
592@cindex big-endian objects
593@cindex endianness
594@kindex -EB
595@item -EB
596Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
597
598@cindex little-endian objects
599@kindex -EL
600@item -EL
601Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
36f63dca 602@end ifclear
252b5132 603
2509a395
SL
604@kindex -f @var{name}
605@kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
606@item -f @var{name}
607@itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
608When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
609to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
610table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
611symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
612
613If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
614run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
615the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
616first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
617@var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
618in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
619Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
620implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
a094d01f 621machine-specific performance.
252b5132
RH
622
623This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
624will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
625
2509a395
SL
626@kindex -F @var{name}
627@kindex --filter=@var{name}
252b5132 628@item -F @var{name}
2509a395 629@itemx --filter=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
630When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
631the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
632of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
633on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
634
635If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
636run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
637dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
638filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
639found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
640used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
641@var{name}.
642
ff5dcc92 643Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
252b5132 644toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
36f63dca
NC
645object files.
646@ifclear SingleFormat
647The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
ece2d90e 648@option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
252b5132 649@code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
36f63dca
NC
650environment variable.
651@end ifclear
652The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
653creating an ELF shared object.
252b5132 654
3dbf70a2 655@cindex finalization function
2509a395
SL
656@kindex -fini=@var{name}
657@item -fini=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
658When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
659executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
660address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
661the function to call.
662
252b5132
RH
663@kindex -g
664@item -g
665Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
666
2509a395
SL
667@kindex -G @var{value}
668@kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
252b5132 669@cindex object size
2509a395 670@item -G @var{value}
252b5132
RH
671@itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
672Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
673@var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
e8044f35 674MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
252b5132
RH
675sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
676
677@cindex runtime library name
2509a395 678@kindex -h @var{name}
252b5132 679@kindex -soname=@var{name}
2509a395 680@item -h @var{name}
252b5132
RH
681@itemx -soname=@var{name}
682When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
683the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
684which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
685linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
686field rather than the using the file name given to the linker.
687
688@kindex -i
689@cindex incremental link
690@item -i
691Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
692
3dbf70a2 693@cindex initialization function
2509a395
SL
694@kindex -init=@var{name}
695@item -init=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
696When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
697executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
698of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
699function to call.
700
252b5132 701@cindex archive files, from cmd line
2509a395 702@kindex -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf 703@kindex --library=@var{namespec}
2509a395 704@item -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf
RS
705@itemx --library=@var{namespec}
706Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
707list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
708If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
07d8eb55 709will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
bcb674cf 710will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
252b5132 711
ff5dcc92 712On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
bcb674cf
RS
713files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
714and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
715called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
716@file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
717indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
718to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
719@var{filename}.
252b5132
RH
720
721The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
722specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
723was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
724command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
725archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
726the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
727
ff5dcc92 728See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
252b5132
RH
729archives multiple times.
730
731You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
732
733@ifset GENERIC
734This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
ff5dcc92 735if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
252b5132
RH
736behaviour of the AIX linker.
737@end ifset
738
739@cindex search directory, from cmd line
2509a395 740@kindex -L @var{dir}
252b5132 741@kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
2509a395 742@item -L @var{searchdir}
252b5132 743@itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
ff5dcc92
SC
744Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
745for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
252b5132
RH
746option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
747in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
748on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
ff5dcc92 749@option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
7d24f02c
KH
750order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
751how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
752option is specified.
252b5132 753
3aa2d05a
NC
754If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
755prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
756@samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
9c8ebd6a 757
252b5132
RH
758@ifset UsesEnvVars
759The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
ff5dcc92 760@samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
252b5132
RH
761some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
762@end ifset
763
764The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
765@code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
766at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
767
768@cindex emulation
769@kindex -m @var{emulation}
2509a395 770@item -m @var{emulation}
252b5132
RH
771Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
772emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
773
774If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
775@code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
776
777Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
778configured.
779
780@cindex link map
781@kindex -M
782@kindex --print-map
783@item -M
784@itemx --print-map
785Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
786information about the link, including the following:
787
788@itemize @bullet
789@item
3b83e13a 790Where object files are mapped into memory.
252b5132
RH
791@item
792How common symbols are allocated.
793@item
794All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
795which caused the archive member to be brought in.
3b83e13a
NC
796@item
797The values assigned to symbols.
798
799Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
800involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
801have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
802linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
803of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
804the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
805linker script containing:
806
807@smallexample
808 foo = 1
809 foo = foo * 4
810 foo = foo + 8
811@end smallexample
812
813will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
814option is used:
815
816@smallexample
817 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
818 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
819 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
820@end smallexample
821
822See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
823scripts.
d2ef37eb 824
06ddcada
AM
825@item
826How GNU properties are merged.
d2ef37eb 827
06ddcada
AM
828When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
829.note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
830These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
d2ef37eb
L
831
832@smallexample
833Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
834@end smallexample
835
06ddcada 836This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
d2ef37eb
L
837merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
838is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
839
840@smallexample
06ddcada 841Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
d2ef37eb
L
842@end smallexample
843
06ddcada 844This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
d2ef37eb
L
845when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
846is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
252b5132
RH
847@end itemize
848
035801ce
FS
849@cindex link map discarded
850@kindex --print-map-discarded
851@kindex --no-print-map-discarded
852@item --print-map-discarded
853@itemx --no-print-map-discarded
854Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
855in the link map. Enabled by default.
856
252b5132
RH
857@kindex -n
858@cindex read-only text
859@cindex NMAGIC
860@kindex --nmagic
861@item -n
862@itemx --nmagic
90f5d9d9
JZ
863Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
864libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
865mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
252b5132
RH
866
867@kindex -N
868@kindex --omagic
869@cindex read/write from cmd line
870@cindex OMAGIC
a1ab1d2a 871@item -N
252b5132
RH
872@itemx --omagic
873Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
63fd3b82
NC
874not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
875libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
4d8907ac
DS
876mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
877is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
878specification published by Microsoft.
63fd3b82
NC
879
880@kindex --no-omagic
881@cindex OMAGIC
882@item --no-omagic
883This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
884sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
885be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
886shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
252b5132
RH
887
888@kindex -o @var{output}
889@kindex --output=@var{output}
890@cindex naming the output file
891@item -o @var{output}
892@itemx --output=@var{output}
ff5dcc92 893Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
252b5132
RH
894option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
895script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
896
f37b21b4
RM
897@kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
898@cindex dependency file
899@item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
900Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
901suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
902that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
903output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
904Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
905Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
906to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
907linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
908@samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
909installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
910distributed makefiles without careful editing.
911
252b5132
RH
912@kindex -O @var{level}
913@cindex generating optimized output
914@item -O @var{level}
ff5dcc92 915If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
252b5132 916the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
98c503ac
NC
917should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
918option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
919the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
920no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
921of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
252b5132 922
387dd777
DP
923@kindex -plugin @var{name}
924@item -plugin @var{name}
925Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
926the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
927automatically added by the complier, when using link time
928optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
929wish.
930
931Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
932from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
933@command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
934those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
41f37a6f 935copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
387dd777 936based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
6c19b93b 937just copy in the newest one.
387dd777 938
26278bb8
UD
939@kindex --push-state
940@cindex push state governing input file handling
941@item --push-state
f9a6a8f0 942The @option{--push-state} allows one to preserve the current state of the
26278bb8
UD
943flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
944restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
945
946The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
947@option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
948@option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
949@option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
950@option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
951@option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
952
953One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
954used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
955listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
956something as follows:
957
958@smallexample
959-Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
960@end smallexample
961
962@kindex --pop-state
963@cindex pop state governing input file handling
67cecaba 964@item --pop-state
26278bb8
UD
965Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
966flags governing input file handling.
967
a712da20
NC
968@kindex -q
969@kindex --emit-relocs
970@cindex retain relocations in final executable
971@item -q
972@itemx --emit-relocs
ba1be17e 973Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
a712da20
NC
974Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
975order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
976in larger executables.
977
dbab7a7b
NC
978This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
979
4f471f39
RS
980@kindex --force-dynamic
981@cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
982@item --force-dynamic
983Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
984to VxWorks targets.
985
252b5132
RH
986@cindex partial link
987@cindex relocatable output
988@kindex -r
1049f94e 989@kindex --relocatable
252b5132 990@item -r
1049f94e 991@itemx --relocatable
252b5132 992Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 993turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
252b5132
RH
994linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
995magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
996@code{OMAGIC}.
ff5dcc92 997@c ; see @option{-N}.
252b5132
RH
998If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
999linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
1000constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1001
62bf86b4
HPN
1002When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1003partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1004relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1005example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1006with input files in other formats at all.
1007
252b5132
RH
1008This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1009
1010@kindex -R @var{file}
1011@kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1012@cindex symbol-only input
1013@item -R @var{filename}
1014@itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1015Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1016relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1017to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1018programs. You may use this option more than once.
1019
ff5dcc92 1020For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 1021followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 1022the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
1023
1024@kindex -s
1025@kindex --strip-all
1026@cindex strip all symbols
a1ab1d2a 1027@item -s
252b5132
RH
1028@itemx --strip-all
1029Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1030
1031@kindex -S
1032@kindex --strip-debug
1033@cindex strip debugger symbols
a1ab1d2a 1034@item -S
252b5132
RH
1035@itemx --strip-debug
1036Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1037
a70f34c0
NC
1038@kindex --strip-discarded
1039@kindex --no-strip-discarded
1040@item --strip-discarded
1041@itemx --no-strip-discarded
1042Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1043Enabled by default.
1044
252b5132
RH
1045@kindex -t
1046@kindex --trace
1047@cindex input files, displaying
a1ab1d2a 1048@item -t
252b5132 1049@itemx --trace
4f4690cd
AM
1050Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1051@samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1052@samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1053and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1054a linker bug report.
252b5132
RH
1055
1056@kindex -T @var{script}
1057@kindex --script=@var{script}
1058@cindex script files
1059@item -T @var{scriptfile}
1060@itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1061Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
ff5dcc92 1062@command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
252b5132 1063@var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
114283d8
NC
1064output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1065the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1066specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1067options accumulate.
252b5132 1068
14be8564
L
1069@kindex -dT @var{script}
1070@kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1071@cindex script files
1072@item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1073@itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1074Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1075
1076This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1077processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1078command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1079@option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1080behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1081command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1082the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1083@samp{gcc}).
1084
252b5132
RH
1085@kindex -u @var{symbol}
1086@kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1087@cindex undefined symbol
1088@item -u @var{symbol}
1089@itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1090Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1091symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1092modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1093different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1094option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1095
0a618243
AB
1096If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1097into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1098undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1099instead.
1100
1101@kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1102@cindex symbols, require defined
1103@cindex defined symbol
1104@item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1105Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1106is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1107is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1108and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1109@code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1110can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1111
252b5132
RH
1112@kindex -Ur
1113@cindex constructors
a1ab1d2a 1114@item -Ur
252b5132
RH
1115For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1116@samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 1117turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
252b5132
RH
1118@emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1119It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1120with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1121be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1122@samp{-r} for the others.
1123
c005eb9e
AB
1124@kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1125@cindex orphan sections
1126@cindex sections, orphan
1127@item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1128Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1129specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1130
1131@var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1132
1133@table @code
1134@item place
1135Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1136the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
d2732b69 1137@samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
c005eb9e
AB
1138
1139@item discard
1140All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1141@samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1142
1143@item warn
1144The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1145issue a warning.
1146
1147@item error
1148The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1149@end table
1150
1151The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1152
577a0623
AM
1153@kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154@item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1155Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1156@var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1157missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1158specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1159multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1160input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1161in a linker script.
a854a4a7 1162
252b5132
RH
1163@kindex -v
1164@kindex -V
1165@kindex --version
1166@cindex version
1167@item -v
1168@itemx --version
1169@itemx -V
ff5dcc92 1170Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
252b5132
RH
1171lists the supported emulations.
1172
1173@kindex -x
1174@kindex --discard-all
1175@cindex deleting local symbols
1176@item -x
1177@itemx --discard-all
1178Delete all local symbols.
1179
1180@kindex -X
1181@kindex --discard-locals
1182@cindex local symbols, deleting
a1ab1d2a 1183@item -X
252b5132 1184@itemx --discard-locals
3c68c38f
BW
1185Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1186system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1187or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
252b5132
RH
1188
1189@kindex -y @var{symbol}
1190@kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1191@cindex symbol tracing
1192@item -y @var{symbol}
1193@itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1194Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1195option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1196to prepend an underscore.
1197
1198This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1199don't know where the reference is coming from.
1200
1201@kindex -Y @var{path}
1202@item -Y @var{path}
1203Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1204for Solaris compatibility.
1205
1206@kindex -z @var{keyword}
1207@item -z @var{keyword}
cd6d6c15
NC
1208The recognized keywords are:
1209@table @samp
1210
e6e2dfbd
AM
1211@item bndplt
1212Always generate BND prefix in PLT entries. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1213
1214@item call-nop=prefix-addr
1215@itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1216@itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1217@itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1218Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1219to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1220@option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1221@option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1222@option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1223@option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1224Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1225
233a0083
L
1226@item cet-report=none
1227@itemx cet-report=warning
1228@itemx cet-report=error
1229Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1230GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1231section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1232linker not report missing properties in input files.
1233@option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1234missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1235the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1236Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1237GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1238turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1239Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1240
cd6d6c15 1241@item combreloc
e6e2dfbd
AM
1242@itemx nocombreloc
1243Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1244dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
cd6d6c15 1245
b8871f35 1246@item common
e6e2dfbd
AM
1247@itemx nocommon
1248Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1249link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1250
1251@item common-page-size=@var{value}
1252Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1253layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1254using pages of this size.
b8871f35 1255
cd6d6c15 1256@item defs
97a232d7
NC
1257Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1258is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1259This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
cd6d6c15 1260
e6e2dfbd
AM
1261@item dynamic-undefined-weak
1262@itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1263Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1264if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1265by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1266@samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1267may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1268selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1269these options.
1270
6aa29e7b
JJ
1271@item execstack
1272Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1273
b039ef04
L
1274@item global
1275This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1276the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1277of subsequently loaded libraries.
1278
93ab9c0d
NC
1279@item globalaudit
1280This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1281This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1282setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1283tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
a05a5b64 1284the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
6c19b93b 1285all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
93ab9c0d 1286
e6e2dfbd
AM
1287@item ibtplt
1288Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1289Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1290
8df93cb5 1291@item ibt
e6e2dfbd
AM
1292Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1293to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1294Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1295
cd6d6c15
NC
1296@item initfirst
1297This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1298It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1299before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1300the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1301the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1302objects.
1303
1304@item interpose
e6e2dfbd
AM
1305Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1306so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1307libraries not so marked.
cd6d6c15 1308
c3805e4c
VDM
1309@item unique
1310@itemx nounique
1311When generating a shared library or other dynamically loadable ELF
1312object mark it as one that should (by default) only ever be loaded once,
1313and only in the main namespace (when using @code{dlmopen}). This is
1314primarily used to mark fundamental libraries such as libc, libpthread et
1315al which do not usually function correctly unless they are the sole instances
1316of themselves. This behaviour can be overridden by the @code{dlmopen} caller
1317and does not apply to certain loading mechanisms (such as audit libraries).
1318
279d901e
L
1319@item lam-u48
1320Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 in .note.gnu.property section
1321to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U48. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1322
1323@item lam-u57
1324Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 in .note.gnu.property section
1325to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U57. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1326
1327@item lam-u48-report=none
1328@itemx lam-u48-report=warning
1329@itemx lam-u48-report=error
1330Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48
1331property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1332@option{lam-u48-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1333linker not report missing properties in input files.
1334@option{lam-u48-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1335missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u48-report=error} will
1336make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1337Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1338
1339@item lam-u57-report=none
1340@itemx lam-u57-report=warning
1341@itemx lam-u57-report=error
1342Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57
1343property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1344@option{lam-u57-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1345linker not report missing properties in input files.
1346@option{lam-u57-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1347missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u57-report=error} will
1348make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1349Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1350
1351@item lam-report=none
1352@itemx lam-report=warning
1353@itemx lam-report=error
1354Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 and
1355GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 properties in input .note.gnu.property
1356section. @option{lam-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1357linker not report missing properties in input files.
1358@option{lam-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1359missing properties in input files. @option{lam-report=error} will make
1360the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1361Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1362
5fa222e4
AM
1363@item lazy
1364When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1365dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1366the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1367Lazy binding is the default.
1368
cd6d6c15 1369@item loadfltr
e6e2dfbd 1370Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
cd6d6c15 1371
e6e2dfbd
AM
1372@item max-page-size=@var{value}
1373Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
cd6d6c15 1374
e6e2dfbd
AM
1375@item muldefs
1376Allow multiple definitions.
b8871f35 1377
cd6d6c15 1378@item nocopyreloc
daf220f0
AM
1379Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1380defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
cd6d6c15
NC
1381
1382@item nodefaultlib
e6e2dfbd
AM
1383Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1384should ignore any default library search paths.
cd6d6c15
NC
1385
1386@item nodelete
e6e2dfbd 1387Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
cd6d6c15
NC
1388
1389@item nodlopen
e6e2dfbd 1390Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
cd6d6c15
NC
1391
1392@item nodump
e6e2dfbd 1393Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
cd6d6c15 1394
6aa29e7b
JJ
1395@item noexecstack
1396Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1397
e6e2dfbd
AM
1398@item noextern-protected-data
1399Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1400library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1401used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1402generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1403module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1404i386 and x86-64.
8dfef1bd 1405
e6e2dfbd
AM
1406@item noreloc-overflow
1407Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1408relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1409overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
6aa29e7b 1410
cd6d6c15
NC
1411@item now
1412When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1413dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
e6e2dfbd
AM
1414when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1415function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1416called.
cd6d6c15
NC
1417
1418@item origin
e6e2dfbd 1419Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
cd6d6c15 1420
6aa29e7b 1421@item relro
e6e2dfbd 1422@itemx norelro
def5c83c
AM
1423Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1424specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1425relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1426than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
e6e2dfbd 1427Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
6aa29e7b 1428
68b00778
L
1429@item report-relative-reloc
1430Report dynamic relative relocations generated by linker. Supported for
1431Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1432
47acac12
L
1433@item separate-code
1434@itemx noseparate-code
1435Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1436specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1437be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1438code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1439
496afd17
L
1440@item unique-symbol
1441@itemx nounique-symbol
1442Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1443".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1444is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1445
e6e2dfbd
AM
1446@item shstk
1447Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1448to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1449Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
24718e3b 1450
04c3a755 1451@item stack-size=@var{value}
e6e2dfbd 1452Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
04c3a755
NS
1453Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1454@code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1455
8ee10e86
AM
1456@item start-stop-gc
1457@itemx nostart-stop-gc
1458@cindex start-stop-gc
1459When @samp{--gc-sections} is in effect, a reference from a retained
1460section to @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} causes all
1461input sections named @code{SECNAME} to also be retained, if
1462@code{SECNAME} is representable as a C identifier and either
1463@code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} is synthesized by the
1464linker. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} disables this effect, allowing
1465sections to be garbage collected as if the special synthesized symbols
1466were not defined. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} has no effect on a
1467definition of @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} in an
1468object file or linker script. Such a definition will prevent the
1469linker providing a synthesized @code{__start_SECNAME} or
1470@code{__stop_SECNAME} respectively, and therefore the special
1471treatment by garbage collection for those references.
1472
cae64165
RM
1473@item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1474@cindex visibility
1475@cindex ELF symbol visibility
1476Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1477@code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1478Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1479@samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1480start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1481compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1482recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1483programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1484between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1485
e6e2dfbd
AM
1486@item text
1487@itemx notext
1488@itemx textoff
a6dbf402
L
1489Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1490or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1491report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
48580982 1492
97a232d7
NC
1493@item undefs
1494Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1495either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1496This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1497
b0ab0693 1498@item x86-64-baseline
32930e4e
L
1499@item x86-64-v2
1500@item x86-64-v3
1501@itemx x86-64-v4
1502Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
b0ab0693 1503@option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
32930e4e
L
1504@option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1505@option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1506@option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1507Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1508
cd6d6c15
NC
1509@end table
1510
ece2d90e 1511Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
252b5132
RH
1512
1513@kindex -(
1514@cindex groups of archives
1515@item -( @var{archives} -)
1516@itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1517The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1518either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1519
1520The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1521references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1522the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1523archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1524object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1525would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
5d3db3e2 1526they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
252b5132
RH
1527resolved.
1528
1529Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1530it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1531more archives.
1532
69da35b5
NC
1533@kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1534@kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1535@item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1536@itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1537Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
2ca22b03 1538recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
69da35b5
NC
1539and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1540the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1541behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1542so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1543restore the old behaviour.
2ca22b03 1544
4a43e768
AM
1545@kindex --as-needed
1546@kindex --no-as-needed
1547@item --as-needed
1548@itemx --no-as-needed
1549This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
ddbb8a31 1550on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
4a43e768
AM
1551the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1552on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
ddbb8a31 1553needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
ffa9430d
AM
1554emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1555non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1240be6b
AM
1556the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1557non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
ffa9430d
AM
1558Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1559the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1560needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1561from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
4a43e768 1562
6418520e
NC
1563Note: On Linux based systems the @option{--as-needed} option also has
1564an affect on the behaviour of the @option{--rpath} and
1565@option{--rpath-link} options. See the description of
1566@option{--rpath-link} for more details.
1567
e56f61be
L
1568@kindex --add-needed
1569@kindex --no-add-needed
1570@item --add-needed
1571@itemx --no-add-needed
ddbb8a31
NC
1572These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1573their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1574options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1575and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
e56f61be 1576
252b5132
RH
1577@kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1578@item -assert @var{keyword}
1579This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1580
1581@kindex -Bdynamic
1582@kindex -dy
1583@kindex -call_shared
1584@item -Bdynamic
1585@itemx -dy
1586@itemx -call_shared
1587Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1588for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1589default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1590for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1591multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
da8bce14 1592@option{-l} options which follow it.
252b5132 1593
a1ab1d2a
UD
1594@kindex -Bgroup
1595@item -Bgroup
1596Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1597section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1598object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
560e09e9
NC
1599@option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1600only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
a1ab1d2a 1601
252b5132
RH
1602@kindex -Bstatic
1603@kindex -dn
1604@kindex -non_shared
1605@kindex -static
a1ab1d2a 1606@item -Bstatic
252b5132
RH
1607@itemx -dn
1608@itemx -non_shared
1609@itemx -static
1610Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1611platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1612variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1613may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
560e09e9 1614library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
e9156f74
NC
1615option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1616option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1617shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1618references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
ece2d90e 1619libraries.
252b5132
RH
1620
1621@kindex -Bsymbolic
1622@item -Bsymbolic
1623When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1624definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1625for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1914e264
AM
1626within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1627platforms which support shared libraries.
252b5132 1628
40b36307
L
1629@kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1630@item -Bsymbolic-functions
1631When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
c0065db7 1632symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
40b36307 1633This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1914e264 1634libraries.
40b36307 1635
cf893b0e
FS
1636@kindex -Bno-symbolic
1637@item -Bno-symbolic
1638This option can cancel previously specified @samp{-Bsymbolic} and
1639@samp{-Bsymbolic-functions}.
1640
55255dae
L
1641@kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1642@item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1643Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1644typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1645global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1646within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1647to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1648in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1649which support shared libraries.
1650
1651The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1652scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1653
40b36307
L
1654@kindex --dynamic-list-data
1655@item --dynamic-list-data
1656Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1657
1658@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1659@item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1660Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1661is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1662
0b8a70d9
L
1663@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1664@item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1665Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1666
252b5132
RH
1667@kindex --check-sections
1668@kindex --no-check-sections
1669@item --check-sections
308b1ffd 1670@itemx --no-check-sections
252b5132 1671Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
7d816a17 1672been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
252b5132
RH
1673perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1674suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1675allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
a05a5b64 1676restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
02b0b1aa
NS
1677Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1678force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1679option.
252b5132 1680
ddbb8a31
NC
1681@kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1682@kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1683@item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1684@itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
9d5777a3 1685This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
ddbb8a31 1686by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
08efffb8 1687command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
ddbb8a31 1688output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
08efffb8 1689input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
ddbb8a31 1690specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
08efffb8
MM
1691follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1692behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
ddbb8a31
NC
1693
1694This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
08efffb8
MM
1695libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1696mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1697their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1698required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1699the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1700dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
ddbb8a31
NC
1701symbols.
1702
252b5132
RH
1703@cindex cross reference table
1704@kindex --cref
1705@item --cref
1706Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1707generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1708Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1709
1710The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1711easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1712sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1713symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
049c1c8e
NC
1714definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1715where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1716symbol are listed.
252b5132 1717
5dba6f05
NA
1718@cindex ctf variables
1719@kindex --ctf-variables
1720@kindex --no-ctf-variables
1721@item --ctf-variables
1722@item --no-ctf-variables
1723The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1724types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1725table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1726conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1727usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1728@option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1729The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1730
1731@cindex ctf type sharing
1732@kindex --ctf-share-types
1733@item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1734Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1735
1736@table @samp
1737@item share-unconflicted
1738Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1739where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1740translation unit. This is the default.
1741
1742@item share-duplicated
1743Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1744dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1745dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1746always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1747larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1748large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1749consumer at runtime.
1750@end table
1751
4818e05f
AM
1752@cindex common allocation
1753@kindex --no-define-common
1754@item --no-define-common
1755This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1756The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1757@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1758
1759The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1760the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1761of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1762forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1763Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1764from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1765This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1766and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1767duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1768paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1769
7bdf4127
AB
1770@cindex group allocation in linker script
1771@cindex section groups
1772@cindex COMDAT
1773@kindex --force-group-allocation
1774@item --force-group-allocation
1775This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1776normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1777default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1778change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1779command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1780effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1781
252b5132 1782@cindex symbols, from command line
2509a395
SL
1783@kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1784@item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
252b5132
RH
1785Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1786address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1787times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1788limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1789context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1790symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1791constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
66bc8739
AM
1792using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1793@emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1794equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
252b5132 1795
54874444
AB
1796The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1797in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1798symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1799placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1800the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1801consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1802@samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1803you are trying to achieve.
1804
252b5132 1805@cindex demangling, from command line
28c309a2 1806@kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132 1807@kindex --no-demangle
28c309a2 1808@item --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132
RH
1809@itemx --no-demangle
1810These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1811and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1812present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1813underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
a1ab1d2a
UD
1814mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1815different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1816to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
28c309a2
NC
1817demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1818is set. These options may be used to override the default.
252b5132
RH
1819
1820@cindex dynamic linker, from command line
506eee22 1821@kindex -I@var{file}
2509a395
SL
1822@kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1823@item -I@var{file}
1824@itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
252b5132
RH
1825Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1826generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1827linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1828doing.
1829
9b8b325a
RF
1830@kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1831@item --no-dynamic-linker
1832When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1833linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1834executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1835entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1836
a70f34c0
NC
1837@kindex --embedded-relocs
1838@item --embedded-relocs
1839This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
a094d01f 1840that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
a70f34c0
NC
1841is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1842targets.
1843
3f0a5f17
ME
1844@kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1845@item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1846Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1847in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1848
7ce691ae 1849@kindex --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd 1850@kindex --no-fatal-warnings
7ce691ae 1851@item --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd
NC
1852@itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1853Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1854with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
7ce691ae 1855
252b5132
RH
1856@kindex --force-exe-suffix
1857@item --force-exe-suffix
1858Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1859
1860If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1861@code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1862the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1863option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1864Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1865it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1866
1867@kindex --gc-sections
1868@kindex --no-gc-sections
1869@cindex garbage collection
c17d87de
NC
1870@item --gc-sections
1871@itemx --no-gc-sections
252b5132 1872Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
ac69cbc6 1873targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
b3549761 1874performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
0f088b2a
KT
1875@samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1876collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1877implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
252b5132 1878
d5465ba2
AM
1879@samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1880examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1881symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1882command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1883referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1884libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1885referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1886the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
b69e1ff3
CC
1887relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1888@samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
d5465ba2 1889
ac69cbc6 1890This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
9d5777a3 1891@samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
b69e1ff3
CC
1892specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1893@samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1894command in the linker script.
ac69cbc6 1895
99fabbc9
JL
1896As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
1897@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
1898
c17d87de
NC
1899@kindex --print-gc-sections
1900@kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1901@cindex garbage collection
1902@item --print-gc-sections
1903@itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1904List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1905printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1906collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1907default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1908be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1909line.
1910
22185505 1911@kindex --gc-keep-exported
1912@cindex garbage collection
1913@item --gc-keep-exported
1914When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1915collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1916default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1917executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1918collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1919Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1920it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1921ELF format targets.
1922
30824704
RM
1923@kindex --print-output-format
1924@cindex output format
1925@item --print-output-format
1926Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1927other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1928in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1929
3604cb1f
TG
1930@kindex --print-memory-usage
1931@cindex memory usage
1932@item --print-memory-usage
1933Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1934the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1935quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1936headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1937parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1938
1939@smallexample
1940Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1941 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
1942 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
1943@end smallexample
1944
252b5132
RH
1945@cindex help
1946@cindex usage
1947@kindex --help
1948@item --help
1949Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1950
ea20a7da
CC
1951@kindex --target-help
1952@item --target-help
a094d01f 1953Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
ea20a7da 1954
2509a395
SL
1955@kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1956@item -Map=@var{mapfile}
252b5132 1957Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
2c72361c
NC
1958@option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
1959@code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
1960
1961Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
1962written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
1963inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
1964file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
1965@code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
1966output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
1967@var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
1968
1969@smallexample
1970 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1971 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1972 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1973 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1974 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
1975 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1976 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
1977 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
1978 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
1979 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
1980@end smallexample
1981
1982It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
1983
1984If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
1985operation.
252b5132
RH
1986
1987@cindex memory usage
1988@kindex --no-keep-memory
1989@item --no-keep-memory
ff5dcc92
SC
1990@command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
1991symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
252b5132 1992instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
ff5dcc92 1993necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
252b5132
RH
1994while linking a large executable.
1995
1996@kindex --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 1997@kindex -z defs
97a232d7 1998@kindex -z undefs
252b5132 1999@item --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 2000@itemx -z defs
560e09e9
NC
2001Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
2002is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
2003The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
2004behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
ece2d90e 2005libraries being linked in.
252b5132 2006
97a232d7
NC
2007The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
2008
aa713662
L
2009@kindex --allow-multiple-definition
2010@kindex -z muldefs
2011@item --allow-multiple-definition
2012@itemx -z muldefs
2013Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
2014report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
2015first definition will be used.
2016
b79e8c78 2017@kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 2018@kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
b79e8c78 2019@item --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 2020@itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
903249d7 2021Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
560e09e9
NC
2022This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
2023determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
2024shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
2025how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
2026
903249d7
NC
2027The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
2028referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
2029an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
2030a shared library.
2031
2032The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
2033libraries specified at link time are that:
2034
2035@itemize @bullet
2036@item
2037A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
2038that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
2039resolvable at load time.
2040@item
2041There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
2042symbols in shared libraries are normal.
2043
2044The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
2045select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
2046architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
2047appropriate memset function.
2048@end itemize
b79e8c78 2049
23ae20f5
NC
2050@kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2051@item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2052If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
2053@var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
2054only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
2055libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
93cf38c0
NC
2056``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
2057undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
2058will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
23ae20f5
NC
2059might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
2060error message will be displayed.
2061
2062The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
2063switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
2064
31941635
L
2065@kindex --no-undefined-version
2066@item --no-undefined-version
2067Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
2068it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
2069will be issued instead.
2070
3e3b46e5
PB
2071@kindex --default-symver
2072@item --default-symver
2073Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
fc0e6df6
PB
2074exported symbols.
2075
2076@kindex --default-imported-symver
2077@item --default-imported-symver
2078Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2079imported symbols.
3e3b46e5 2080
252b5132
RH
2081@kindex --no-warn-mismatch
2082@item --no-warn-mismatch
ff5dcc92 2083Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
252b5132
RH
2084files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
2085been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
ff5dcc92 2086This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
252b5132
RH
2087errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2088have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2089inappropriate.
2090
fe7929ce
AM
2091@kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2092@item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2093Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2094library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2095
252b5132
RH
2096@kindex --no-whole-archive
2097@item --no-whole-archive
ff5dcc92 2098Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
252b5132
RH
2099archive files.
2100
2101@cindex output file after errors
2102@kindex --noinhibit-exec
2103@item --noinhibit-exec
2104Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2105Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2106errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2107when it issues any error whatsoever.
2108
0a9c1c8e
CD
2109@kindex -nostdlib
2110@item -nostdlib
2111Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2112command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2113(including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2114
252b5132 2115@ifclear SingleFormat
2509a395
SL
2116@kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2117@item --oformat=@var{output-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
2118@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2119file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 2120@samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
ff5dcc92
SC
2121object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2122object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
2123should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2124usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2125name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2126list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2127command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2128this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2129@end ifclear
2130
76359541
TP
2131@kindex --out-implib
2132@item --out-implib @var{file}
2133Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2134the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2135library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2136may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2137behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2138step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2139the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2140
36af4a4e
JJ
2141@kindex -pie
2142@kindex --pic-executable
2143@item -pie
2144@itemx --pic-executable
2145@cindex position independent executables
2146Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2147ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2148libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
7e7d5768 2149address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
36af4a4e
JJ
2150normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2151defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2152
252b5132
RH
2153@kindex -qmagic
2154@item -qmagic
2155This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2156
2157@kindex -Qy
2158@item -Qy
2159This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2160
2161@kindex --relax
2162@cindex synthesizing linker
2163@cindex relaxing addressing modes
28d5f677 2164@cindex --no-relax
252b5132 2165@item --relax
28d5f677 2166@itemx --no-relax
a1ab1d2a 2167An option with machine dependent effects.
252b5132
RH
2168@ifset GENERIC
2169This option is only supported on a few targets.
2170@end ifset
2171@ifset H8300
ff5dcc92 2172@xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
252b5132 2173@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
2174@ifset XTENSA
2175@xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2176@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
2177@ifset M68HC11
2178@xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2179@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
2180@ifset NIOSII
2181@xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2182@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
2183@ifset POWERPC
2184@xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2185@end ifset
252b5132 2186
ccd9fae5 2187On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
28d5f677
NC
2188global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2189addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2190synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
11e7fd74 2191instructions, and combining constant values.
252b5132
RH
2192
2193On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2194debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2195@ifset GENERIC
28d5f677
NC
2196This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2197family of processors.
252b5132
RH
2198@end ifset
2199
ccd9fae5
NC
2200On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2201@option{--no-relax} will disable it.
28d5f677 2202
ccd9fae5
NC
2203On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2204and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2205
252b5132
RH
2206@cindex retaining specified symbols
2207@cindex stripping all but some symbols
2208@cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2509a395
SL
2209@kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2210@item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
252b5132
RH
2211Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2212discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2213symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2214@ifset GENERIC
2215(such as VxWorks)
2216@end ifset
2217where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2218run-time memory.
2219
2220@samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2221or symbols needed for relocations.
2222
2223You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2224line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2225
2226@ifset GENERIC
2509a395 2227@item -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2228@cindex runtime library search path
2509a395 2229@kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2230Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
ff5dcc92 2231linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
252b5132 2232arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
c1b00498
MR
2233them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2234
2235The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2236are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2237description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2238in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2239have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2240
2241If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2242contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2243is defined.
252b5132 2244
ff5dcc92 2245The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
d8506323 2246SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
ff5dcc92
SC
2247@option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2248runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2249options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2250gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
b45619c0 2251file systems.
252b5132 2252
ff5dcc92 2253For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 2254followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 2255the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
2256@end ifset
2257
2258@ifset GENERIC
2259@cindex link-time runtime library search path
2509a395
SL
2260@kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2261@item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
252b5132
RH
2262When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2263happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2264of the input files.
2265
2266When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2267non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2268shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
ff5dcc92 2269explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
252b5132 2270specifies the first set of directories to search. The
ff5dcc92 2271@option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
252b5132
RH
2272either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2273appearing multiple times.
2274
e680a6b6
NC
2275The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2276directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2277containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2278and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
227964-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2280
2281The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2282@var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2283supported.
2284
28c309a2
NC
2285This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2286that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2287is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2288runtime linker would do.
2289
252b5132 2290The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
ece2d90e 2291libraries:
d8e4137b 2292
252b5132
RH
2293@enumerate
2294@item
ff5dcc92 2295Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
252b5132 2296@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2297Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2298between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2299specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2300used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
ece2d90e
NC
2301at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2302by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2303the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
252b5132 2304@item
e2a83dd0
NC
2305On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2306@option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2307environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
252b5132 2308@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2309On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2310directories specified using @option{-L} options.
252b5132 2311@item
a1b8d843 2312For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
e2a83dd0 2313variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
252b5132 2314@item
ec4eb78a
L
2315For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2316@code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2317libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2318@code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2319@item
252b5132
RH
2320The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2321@item
d8e4137b
NC
2322For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2323exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2324to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2325defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2326configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2327@item
2328For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2329the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2330header file.
2331@item
2332Any directories specifed by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in the
2333linker script being used.
252b5132
RH
2334@end enumerate
2335
6418520e
NC
2336Note however on Linux based systems there is an additional caveat: If
2337the @option{--as-needed} option is active @emph{and} a shared library
2338is located which would normally satisfy the search @emph{and} this
2339library does not have DT_NEEDED tag for @file{libc.so}
2340@emph{and} there is a shared library later on in the set of search
2341directories which also satisfies the search @emph{and}
2342this second shared library does have a DT_NEEDED tag for
2343@file{libc.so} @emph{then} the second library will be selected instead
2344of the first.
2345
252b5132
RH
2346If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2347warning and continue with the link.
6418520e 2348
252b5132
RH
2349@end ifset
2350
2351@kindex -shared
2352@kindex -Bshareable
2353@item -shared
2354@itemx -Bshareable
2355@cindex shared libraries
2356Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2357and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
ff5dcc92 2358shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
252b5132
RH
2359undefined symbols in the link.
2360
252b5132 2361@kindex --sort-common
2509a395
SL
2362@item --sort-common
2363@itemx --sort-common=ascending
2364@itemx --sort-common=descending
de7dd2bd
NC
2365This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2366ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2367sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2368eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2369between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2370specified, then descending order is assumed.
252b5132 2371
2509a395
SL
2372@kindex --sort-section=name
2373@item --sort-section=name
bcaa7b3e
L
2374This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2375patterns in the linker script.
2376
2509a395
SL
2377@kindex --sort-section=alignment
2378@item --sort-section=alignment
bcaa7b3e
L
2379This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2380patterns in the linker script.
2381
a70f34c0
NC
2382@kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2383@item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2384This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2385.dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2386post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2387
252b5132 2388@kindex --split-by-file
2509a395 2389@item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
ff5dcc92 2390Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
a854a4a7
AM
2391each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2392size of 1 if not given.
252b5132
RH
2393
2394@kindex --split-by-reloc
2509a395 2395@item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
a854a4a7 2396Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
252b5132 2397output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
a854a4a7 2398This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
252b5132
RH
2399certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2400cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2401that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2402support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2403input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2404more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
a854a4a7 2405many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
252b5132
RH
2406
2407@kindex --stats
2408@item --stats
2409Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2410as execution time and memory usage.
2411
2509a395 2412@kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
e2243057
RS
2413@item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2414Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2415configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2416that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2417
a70f34c0
NC
2418@kindex --task-link
2419@item --task-link
2420This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2421file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2422
252b5132
RH
2423@kindex --traditional-format
2424@cindex traditional format
2425@item --traditional-format
ff5dcc92
SC
2426For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2427the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
252b5132
RH
2428use the traditional format instead.
2429
2430@cindex dbx
ff5dcc92 2431For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
252b5132
RH
2432symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2433full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2434@code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
ff5dcc92 2435trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
252b5132
RH
2436combine duplicate entries.
2437
2509a395
SL
2438@kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2439@item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
176355da
NC
2440Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2441address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2442times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2443line.
2444@var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2445for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2446@samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2447should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2448sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2449
2509a395
SL
2450@kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2451@kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2452@kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
252b5132 2453@cindex segment origins, cmd line
2509a395
SL
2454@item -Tbss=@var{org}
2455@itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2456@itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2457Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
a6e02871 2458@code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
252b5132 2459
2509a395
SL
2460@kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2461@item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
258795f5 2462@cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2b8c06a3
L
2463When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2464byte of the text segment.
258795f5 2465
9d5777a3
RM
2466@kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2467@item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2468@cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2469When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2470the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2471text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2472
0d705e9f
AM
2473@kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2474@item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2475@cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2476When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2477model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2478
560e09e9
NC
2479@kindex --unresolved-symbols
2480@item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2481Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2482values for @samp{method}:
2483
2484@table @samp
2485@item ignore-all
da8bce14 2486Do not report any unresolved symbols.
560e09e9
NC
2487
2488@item report-all
da8bce14 2489Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
560e09e9
NC
2490
2491@item ignore-in-object-files
2492Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2493ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2494
2495@item ignore-in-shared-libs
2496Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2497ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2498when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2499libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2500command line.
2501@end table
2502
2503The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2504by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2505
2506Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2507unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2508can change this to a warning.
2509
1715a13c
L
2510@kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2511@cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
252b5132 2512@item --dll-verbose
1715a13c 2513@itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
ff5dcc92 2514Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
252b5132 2515supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
1715a13c
L
2516the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2517argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
252b5132
RH
2518
2519@kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2520@cindex version script, symbol versions
2509a395 2521@item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
252b5132
RH
2522Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2523used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
36f63dca 2524about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
09e2aba4
DK
2525is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2526see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2527use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2528symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2529@xref{WIN32}.
252b5132 2530
7ce691ae 2531@kindex --warn-common
252b5132
RH
2532@cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2533@cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2534@item --warn-common
2535Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
11e7fd74 2536a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
252b5132
RH
2537but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2538you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
11e7fd74 2539Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
252b5132
RH
2540warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2541
2542There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2543
2544@table @samp
2545@item int i = 1;
2546A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2547file.
2548
2549@item extern int i;
2550An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2551There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2552variable somewhere.
2553
2554@item int i;
2555A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2556variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2557The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2558single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2559size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2560a definition of the same variable.
2561@end table
2562
2563The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2564Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2565just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2566encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2567a common symbol.
2568
2569@enumerate
2570@item
2571Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2572definition for the symbol.
2573@smallexample
2574@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2575 overridden by definition
2576@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2577@end smallexample
2578
2579@item
2580Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2581the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2582except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2583@smallexample
2584@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2585 overriding common
2586@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2587@end smallexample
2588
2589@item
2590Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2591@smallexample
2592@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2593 of `@var{symbol}'
2594@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2595@end smallexample
2596
2597@item
2598Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2599@smallexample
2600@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2601 overridden by larger common
2602@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2603@end smallexample
2604
2605@item
2606Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2607the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2608encountered in a different order.
2609@smallexample
2610@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2611 overriding smaller common
2612@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2613@end smallexample
2614@end enumerate
2615
2616@kindex --warn-constructors
2617@item --warn-constructors
2618Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2619object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2620detect the use of global constructors.
2621
2622@kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2623@item --warn-multiple-gp
2624Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2625This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2626Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2627section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2628of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2629base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2630base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2631bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2632large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2633values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2634option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2635
2636@kindex --warn-once
2637@cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2638@cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2639@item --warn-once
2640Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2641which refers to it.
2642
2643@kindex --warn-section-align
2644@cindex warnings, on section alignment
2645@cindex section alignment, warnings on
2646@item --warn-section-align
2647Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2648alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2649The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2650is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2651the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2652
a6dbf402
L
2653@kindex --warn-textrel
2654@item --warn-textrel
2655Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2656or shared object.
8fdd7217 2657
a0c402a5
L
2658@kindex --warn-alternate-em
2659@item --warn-alternate-em
2660Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2661
560e09e9
NC
2662@kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2663@item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2664If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2665@option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2666This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2667
2668@kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2669@item --error-unresolved-symbols
2670This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2671it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2672
252b5132
RH
2673@kindex --whole-archive
2674@cindex including an entire archive
2675@item --whole-archive
2676For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
ff5dcc92 2677@option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
252b5132
RH
2678in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2679files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2680library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2681library. This option may be used more than once.
2682
7ec229ce 2683Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
ff5dcc92
SC
2684about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2685Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
7ec229ce
DD
2686list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2687your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2688
2509a395
SL
2689@kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2690@item --wrap=@var{symbol}
252b5132
RH
2691Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2692@var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2693undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2694@var{symbol}.
2695
2696This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2697wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2698wishes to call the system function, it should call
2699@code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2700
2701Here is a trivial example:
2702
2703@smallexample
2704void *
cc2f008e 2705__wrap_malloc (size_t c)
252b5132 2706@{
cc2f008e 2707 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
252b5132
RH
2708 return __real_malloc (c);
2709@}
2710@end smallexample
2711
ff5dcc92 2712If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
252b5132
RH
2713all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2714instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2715call the real @code{malloc} function.
2716
2717You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
ff5dcc92 2718links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
252b5132
RH
2719you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2720file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2721call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2722
4ea904ed
SH
2723Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2724internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2725@code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2726@code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2727
2728@smallexample
2729int
2730f (void)
2731@{
2732 return 123;
2733@}
2734
2735int
2736g (void)
2737@{
2738 return f();
2739@}
2740@end smallexample
2741
6aa29e7b 2742@kindex --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b 2743@kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
6aa29e7b 2744@item --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b
NC
2745@itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2746Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2747(@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2748section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
6aa29e7b 2749
e41b3a13
JJ
2750@kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2751@item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2752Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2753generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2754if linker generated unwind info is supported.
2755
6c1439be
L
2756@kindex --enable-new-dtags
2757@kindex --disable-new-dtags
2758@item --enable-new-dtags
2759@itemx --disable-new-dtags
2760This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2761systems may not understand them. If you specify
b1b00fcc
MF
2762@option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2763and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
ff5dcc92 2764If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
6c1439be
L
2765created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2766those options are only available for ELF systems.
2767
2d643429 2768@kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
e185dd51 2769@item --hash-size=@var{number}
2d643429
NC
2770Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2771close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2772time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2773increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2774value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2775
fdc90cb4
JJ
2776@kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2777@item --hash-style=@var{style}
2778Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2779@code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2780new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2781the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
c8455dc9
NC
2782hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2783but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
fdc90cb4 2784
0ce398f1
L
2785@kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2786@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2787@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2788@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2789@item --compress-debug-sections=none
2790@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2791@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2792@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
9af89fba
NC
2793On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2794compressed using zlib.
2795
2796@option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2797sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2798DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2799instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2800also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2801sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2802
2803The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2804@option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2805
2806Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2807sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2808for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2809uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2810
2811The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2812involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2813default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2814@option{--help} option.
0ce398f1 2815
35835446
JR
2816@kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2817@item --reduce-memory-overheads
2818This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
f2a8f148 2819linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
35835446 2820for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2d643429
NC
2821about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2822
4f9c04f7 2823Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2d643429 28241021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
a85785bc 2825run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2d643429
NC
2826has been used.
2827
2828The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2829enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
35835446 2830
c0065db7
RM
2831@kindex --build-id
2832@kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2833@item --build-id
2834@itemx --build-id=@var{style}
61e2488c 2835Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
6033bf41 2836or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
61e2488c
JT
2837unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2838@code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2839@sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2840@code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2841the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2842string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2843@code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2844is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
24382dca
RM
2845
2846The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2847that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2848unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2849to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2850file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2851string identifying the original linked file does not change.
c0065db7
RM
2852
2853Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2854@code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
252b5132
RH
2855@end table
2856
0285c67d
NC
2857@c man end
2858
36f63dca 2859@subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
252b5132 2860
0285c67d
NC
2861@c man begin OPTIONS
2862
ff5dcc92 2863The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
252b5132
RH
2864the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2865normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2866use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2867@code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2868like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2869symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2870object file).
2871
2872In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
a05a5b64 2873support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
252b5132
RH
2874PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
2875values by either a space or an equals sign.
2876
ff5dcc92 2877@table @gcctabopt
252b5132
RH
2878
2879@kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2880@item --add-stdcall-alias
2881If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2882as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
bb10df36 2883[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2884
2885@kindex --base-file
2886@item --base-file @var{file}
2887Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2888addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2889@file{dlltool}.
bb10df36 2890[This is an i386 PE specific option]
252b5132
RH
2891
2892@kindex --dll
2893@item --dll
2894Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
ff5dcc92 2895@option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
252b5132 2896file.
bb10df36 2897[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2898
88183869
DK
2899@kindex --enable-long-section-names
2900@kindex --disable-long-section-names
2901@item --enable-long-section-names
2902@itemx --disable-long-section-names
56e6cf80 2903The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
88183869 2904the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
56e6cf80
NC
2905for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
2906fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
88183869
DK
2907to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
2908allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
2909disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
2910generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
2911as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
9d5777a3
RM
2912with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
2913GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3efd345c
DK
2914information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
2915option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
2916section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
2917when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
2918image and not stripping symbols.
88183869
DK
2919[This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
2920
252b5132
RH
2921@kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
2922@kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
2923@item --enable-stdcall-fixup
2924@itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
2925If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
36f63dca 2926do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
252b5132
RH
2927only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
2928resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
2929undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
2930@code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
2931to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
2932warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
2933import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
ff5dcc92 2934to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
252b5132 2935feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
ff5dcc92 2936@option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
252b5132 2937mismatches are considered to be errors.
bb10df36 2938[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2939
522f09cd
KT
2940@kindex --leading-underscore
2941@kindex --no-leading-underscore
2942@item --leading-underscore
2943@itemx --no-leading-underscore
2944For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
2945in target's description. By this option it is possible to
2946disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
2947
252b5132
RH
2948@cindex DLLs, creating
2949@kindex --export-all-symbols
2950@item --export-all-symbols
2951If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
2952be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
2953otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
2954explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
2955attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
2956option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
ece2d90e 2957@code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
b044cda1 2958@code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
ece2d90e
NC
2959exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
2960re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
2961such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
2962@code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
b044cda1
CW
2963@code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
2964Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
2965not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
ece2d90e 2966extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
b044cda1 2967(obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
ece2d90e 2968These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
b044cda1 2969@code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
ece2d90e 2970@code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
b044cda1 2971@code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
ece2d90e 2972@code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
bb10df36 2973[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2974
2975@kindex --exclude-symbols
1d0a3c9c 2976@item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
252b5132
RH
2977Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
2978exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
bb10df36 2979[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2980
2927aaca
NC
2981@kindex --exclude-all-symbols
2982@item --exclude-all-symbols
2983Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
2984[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2985
252b5132
RH
2986@kindex --file-alignment
2987@item --file-alignment
2988Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
2989file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
2990512.
bb10df36 2991[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2992
2993@cindex heap size
2994@kindex --heap
2995@item --heap @var{reserve}
2996@itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 2997Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 2998to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 2999committed.
bb10df36 3000[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3001
3002@cindex image base
3003@kindex --image-base
3004@item --image-base @var{value}
3005Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
3006the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
3007is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
3008your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
3009other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
3010for dlls.
bb10df36 3011[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3012
3013@kindex --kill-at
3014@item --kill-at
3015If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
3016symbols before they are exported.
bb10df36 3017[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3018
26d2d8a2
BF
3019@kindex --large-address-aware
3020@item --large-address-aware
b45619c0 3021If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
26d2d8a2 3022header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
b45619c0 3023greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
26d2d8a2
BF
3024or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
3025section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
3026[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3027
f69a2f97
NC
3028@kindex --disable-large-address-aware
3029@item --disable-large-address-aware
3030Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
3031This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
3032driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
3033addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
3034[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3035
252b5132
RH
3036@kindex --major-image-version
3037@item --major-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3038Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
bb10df36 3039[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3040
3041@kindex --major-os-version
3042@item --major-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3043Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3044[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3045
3046@kindex --major-subsystem-version
3047@item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3048Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3049[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3050
3051@kindex --minor-image-version
3052@item --minor-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3053Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3054[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3055
3056@kindex --minor-os-version
3057@item --minor-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3058Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3059[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3060
3061@kindex --minor-subsystem-version
3062@item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3063Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3064[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3065
3066@cindex DEF files, creating
3067@cindex DLLs, creating
3068@kindex --output-def
3069@item --output-def @var{file}
3070The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
3071file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
3072(which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
3073library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
3074automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
bb10df36 3075[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3076
b044cda1 3077@cindex DLLs, creating
b044cda1
CW
3078@kindex --enable-auto-image-base
3079@item --enable-auto-image-base
d0e6d77b
CF
3080@itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
3081Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
3082@var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
3083By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
3084for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
3085execution are avoided.
bb10df36 3086[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3087
3088@kindex --disable-auto-image-base
3089@item --disable-auto-image-base
3090Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
3091user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
3092default.
bb10df36 3093[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3094
3095@cindex DLLs, linking to
3096@kindex --dll-search-prefix
3097@item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
489d0400 3098When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
ece2d90e 3099search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
560e09e9 3100@code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
b044cda1
CW
3101between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3102uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
ece2d90e 3103@code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
bb10df36 3104[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3105
3106@kindex --enable-auto-import
3107@item --enable-auto-import
ece2d90e 3108Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
317ff008
EB
3109DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3110mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3111[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3112
3113The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3114feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3115
3116Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3117of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3118PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
4d8907ac 3119
e2a83dd0
NC
3120Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3121data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3122placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3123around a problem with consts that is described here:
3124http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3125
4d8907ac
DS
3126Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3127see this message:
0d888aac 3128
ece2d90e 3129"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
0d888aac
CW
3130documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3131
ece2d90e
NC
3132This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3133ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
c0065db7
RM
3134allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3135fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3136constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
2f8d8971
NC
3137multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3138this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3139of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3140the warning, and exit.
3141
3142There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3143data type of the exported variable:
0d888aac 3144
2fa9fc65
NC
3145One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3146of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
560e09e9 3147this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
2fa9fc65 3148
c0065db7
RM
3149A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3150that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3151there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
0d888aac
CW
3152a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3153
3154@example
3155extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3156extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3157 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3158@end example
3159
3160or
3161
3162@example
3163extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3164extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3165 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3166@end example
3167
c0065db7 3168For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
2f8d8971 3169is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
0d888aac
CW
3170
3171@example
3172extern struct s extern_struct;
c0065db7 3173extern_struct.field -->
0d888aac
CW
3174 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3175@end example
3176
c406afaf
NC
3177or
3178
3179@example
3180extern long long extern_ll;
3181extern_ll -->
3182 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3183@end example
3184
2fa9fc65 3185A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
c0065db7 3186'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
11e7fd74 3187@code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
0d888aac 3188requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
c0065db7
RM
3189building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3190merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3191between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
0d888aac
CW
3192constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3193
3194Original:
3195@example
3196--foo.h
3197extern int arr[];
3198--foo.c
3199#include "foo.h"
3200void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3201 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3202@}
3203@end example
3204
3205Solution 1:
3206@example
3207--foo.h
3208extern int arr[];
3209--foo.c
3210#include "foo.h"
3211void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3212 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3213 volatile int *parr = arr;
3214 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3215@}
3216@end example
3217
3218Solution 2:
3219@example
3220--foo.h
3221/* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3222#if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3223 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3224#define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3225#else
3226#define FOO_IMPORT
3227#endif
3228extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3229--foo.c
3230#include "foo.h"
3231void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3232 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3233@}
3234@end example
3235
c0065db7 3236A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
0d888aac
CW
3237library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3238for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3239functions).
b044cda1
CW
3240
3241@kindex --disable-auto-import
3242@item --disable-auto-import
c0065db7 3243Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
b044cda1 3244@code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3245[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3246
2fa9fc65
NC
3247@kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3248@item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3249If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3250that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3251a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
c0065db7 3252environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
bb10df36 3253[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65
NC
3254
3255@kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3256@item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
317ff008 3257Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3258[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65 3259
b044cda1
CW
3260@kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3261@item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3262Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
bb10df36 3263[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3264
252b5132
RH
3265@kindex --section-alignment
3266@item --section-alignment
3267Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3268addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
bb10df36 3269[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3270
3271@cindex stack size
3272@kindex --stack
3273@item --stack @var{reserve}
3274@itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3275Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3276to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3277committed.
bb10df36 3278[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3279
3280@kindex --subsystem
3281@item --subsystem @var{which}
3282@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3283@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3284Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3285legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
33f362e1
NC
3286@code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3287the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3288@var{which}.
bb10df36 3289[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3290
2f563b51
DK
3291The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3292of the PE file header:
3293[These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3294
2d5c3743
NC
3295@kindex --high-entropy-va
3296@item --high-entropy-va
514b4e19 3297@itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
2d5c3743 3298Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
514b4e19
JD
3299(ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3300
dc9bd8c9
HD
3301This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3302@option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2d5c3743 3303
2f563b51
DK
3304@kindex --dynamicbase
3305@item --dynamicbase
514b4e19 3306@itemx --disable-dynamicbase
2f563b51
DK
3307The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3308randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
514b4e19
JD
3309Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3310can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
dc9bd8c9 3311This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2f563b51
DK
3312
3313@kindex --forceinteg
3314@item --forceinteg
514b4e19
JD
3315@itemx --disable-forceinteg
3316Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3317default.
2f563b51
DK
3318
3319@kindex --nxcompat
3320@item --nxcompat
514b4e19 3321@item --disable-nxcompat
2f563b51 3322The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
514b4e19
JD
3323This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3324targets. The option is enabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3325
3326@kindex --no-isolation
3327@item --no-isolation
514b4e19 3328@itemx --disable-no-isolation
2f563b51 3329Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
514b4e19 3330This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3331
3332@kindex --no-seh
3333@item --no-seh
514b4e19 3334@itemx --disable-no-seh
2f563b51 3335The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
514b4e19 3336this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3337
3338@kindex --no-bind
3339@item --no-bind
514b4e19
JD
3340@itemx --disable-no-bind
3341Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3342
3343@kindex --wdmdriver
3344@item --wdmdriver
514b4e19
JD
3345@itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3346The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3347by default.
9d5777a3 3348
2f563b51
DK
3349@kindex --tsaware
3350@item --tsaware
514b4e19
JD
3351@itemx --disable-tsaware
3352The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3353default.
2f563b51 3354
0cb112f7
CF
3355@kindex --insert-timestamp
3356@item --insert-timestamp
eeb14e5a
LZ
3357@itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3358Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3359as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3360other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
56e6cf80 3361will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
eeb14e5a
LZ
3362same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3363can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
56e6cf80 3364that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
eeb14e5a 3365identically.
dc9bd8c9
HD
3366
3367@kindex --enable-reloc-section
3368@item --enable-reloc-section
514b4e19 3369@itemx --disable-reloc-section
dc9bd8c9
HD
3370Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3371is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
514b4e19 3372This option is enabled by default.
252b5132
RH
3373@end table
3374
0285c67d
NC
3375@c man end
3376
ac145307
BS
3377@ifset C6X
3378@subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3379
3380@c man begin OPTIONS
3381
3382The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3383libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3384all executables use an index of 0.
3385
3386@table @gcctabopt
3387
3388@kindex --dsbt-size
3389@item --dsbt-size @var{size}
56e6cf80 3390This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
ac145307
BS
3391or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3392entries.
3393
3394@kindex --dsbt-index
3395@item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3396This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3397to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3398executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3399@code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3400
fbd9ad90
PB
3401@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3402The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3403exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3404
ac145307
BS
3405@end table
3406
3407@c man end
3408@end ifset
3409
b8891f8d
AJ
3410@ifset CSKY
3411@subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3412
3413@c man begin OPTIONS
3414
3415@table @gcctabopt
3416
3417@kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3418@item --branch-stub
3419This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3420sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3421usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3422can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3423the compiler or assembler.
3424
3425@kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3426@item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3427This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3428It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3429be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3430stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3431sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3432@samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3433linker should choose suitable defaults.
3434
3435@end table
3436
3437@c man end
3438@end ifset
3439
93fd0973
SC
3440@ifset M68HC11
3441@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3442
3443@c man begin OPTIONS
3444
3445The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3446memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3447
3448@table @gcctabopt
3449
3450@kindex --no-trampoline
3451@item --no-trampoline
3452This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3453is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3454instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3455
3456@kindex --bank-window
3457@item --bank-window @var{name}
3458This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3459the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3460The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3461paging and addresses within the memory window.
3462
3463@end table
3464
3465@c man end
3466@end ifset
3467
7fb9f789
NC
3468@ifset M68K
3469@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3470
3471@c man begin OPTIONS
3472
3473The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3474when linking for 68K targets.
3475
3476@table @gcctabopt
3477
3478@kindex --got
3479@item --got=@var{type}
3480This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3481@var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3482@samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3483Info entry for @file{ld}.
3484
3485@end table
3486
3487@c man end
3488@end ifset
3489
833794fc
MR
3490@ifset MIPS
3491@subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3492
3493@c man begin OPTIONS
3494
3495The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
8b10b0b3
MR
3496generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3497linking for MIPS targets.
833794fc
MR
3498
3499@table @gcctabopt
3500
3501@kindex --insn32
3502@item --insn32
3503@kindex --no-insn32
3504@itemx --no-insn32
3505These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3506generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3507or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
350832-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3509used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3510possible.
3511
8b10b0b3
MR
3512@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3513@item --ignore-branch-isa
3514@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3515@itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3516These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3517transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3518accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3519is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3520instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3521equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3522calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3523a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3524an error.
3525
3734320d
MF
3526@kindex --compact-branches
3527@item --compact-branches
3528@kindex --no-compact-branches
fa1477dc 3529@itemx --no-compact-branches
3734320d
MF
3530These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3531in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3532
833794fc
MR
3533@end table
3534
3535@c man end
3536@end ifset
3537
fa1477dc
SC
3538
3539@ifset PDP11
3540@subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3541
3542@c man begin OPTIONS
3543
3544For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3545produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3546for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3547targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3548defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3549here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3550
3551@table @gcctabopt
3552
3553@kindex -N
3554@item -N
3555@kindex --omagic
3556@itemx --omagic
3557
3558Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3559indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3560shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3561writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3562the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3563programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3564from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3565
3566@kindex -n
3567@item -n
3568@kindex --nmagic
3569@itemx --nmagic
3570
3571Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3572indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3573be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3574file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3575byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3576a @emph{pure executable} format.
3577
3578@kindex -z
3579@item -z
3580@kindex --imagic
3581@itemx --imagic
3582
3583Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3584indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3585data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3586instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3587larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3588to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3589shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3590option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3591and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3592this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3593executable} format.
3594
3595@kindex --no-omagic
3596@item --no-omagic
3597
3598Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3599
3600@end table
3601
3602@c man end
3603@end ifset
3604
252b5132
RH
3605@ifset UsesEnvVars
3606@node Environment
3607@section Environment Variables
3608
0285c67d
NC
3609@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3610
560e09e9 3611You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
36f63dca
NC
3612@ifclear SingleFormat
3613@code{GNUTARGET},
3614@end ifclear
3615@code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
252b5132 3616
36f63dca 3617@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
3618@kindex GNUTARGET
3619@cindex default input format
3620@code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3621use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3622of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
ff5dcc92 3623@code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
252b5132
RH
3624of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3625attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3626this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3627there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3628object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3629BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3630in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
36f63dca 3631@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
3632
3633@kindex LDEMULATION
3634@cindex default emulation
3635@cindex emulation, default
3636@code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3637@samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3638behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3639available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3640the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3641variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3642linker was configured.
252b5132
RH
3643
3644@kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3645@cindex demangling, default
3646Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3647@code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3648default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3649a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3650may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3651options.
3652
0285c67d
NC
3653@c man end
3654@end ifset
3655
252b5132
RH
3656@node Scripts
3657@chapter Linker Scripts
3658
3659@cindex scripts
3660@cindex linker scripts
3661@cindex command files
3662Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3663written in the linker command language.
3664
3665The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3666the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3667the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3668more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3669direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3670described below.
3671
3672The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3673yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
a05a5b64
TP
3674linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3675to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
252b5132
RH
3676such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3677
3678You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3679line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3680default linker script.
3681
3682You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3683to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3684Linker Scripts}.
3685
3686@menu
3687* Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3688* Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3689* Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3690* Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3691* Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3692* SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3693* MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3694* PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3695* VERSION:: VERSION Command
3696* Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3697* Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3698@end menu
3699
3700@node Basic Script Concepts
3701@section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3702@cindex linker script concepts
3703We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3704describe the linker script language.
3705
3706The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3707file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3708@dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3709The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3710purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3711among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3712section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3713in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3714
3715Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3716also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
56dd11f0 3717contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
252b5132
RH
3718the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3719A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3720area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3721loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3722which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3723of debugging information.
3724
3725Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3726first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3727the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3728@dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3729section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3730same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3731is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3732(this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3733based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3734RAM address would be the VMA.
3735
3736You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3737program with the @samp{-h} option.
3738
3739Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3740@dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3741has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3742information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3743will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3744static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3745referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3746
3747You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3748program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3749option.
3750
3751@node Script Format
3752@section Linker Script Format
3753@cindex linker script format
3754Linker scripts are text files.
3755
3756You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3757either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3758symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3759generally ignored.
3760
3761Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3762If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3763otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3764double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3765file name.
3766
3767You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3768@samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3769to whitespace.
3770
3771@node Simple Example
3772@section Simple Linker Script Example
3773@cindex linker script example
3774@cindex example of linker script
3775Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3776
3777The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3778@samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3779memory layout of the output file.
3780
3781The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3782describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3783code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3784@samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3785Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3786your input files.
3787
3788For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
37890x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3790linker script which will do that:
3791@smallexample
3792SECTIONS
3793@{
3794 . = 0x10000;
3795 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3796 . = 0x8000000;
3797 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3798 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3799@}
3800@end smallexample
3801
3802You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3803followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3804descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3805
252b5132
RH
3806The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3807sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3808counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3809other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3810current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3811incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3812@samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3813
3814The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3815required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3816after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3817which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3818wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3819means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3820
3821Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3822@samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3823@samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3824
3825The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3826the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3827at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3828output section, the value of the location counter will be
3829@samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3830effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
58434bc1 3831immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
252b5132
RH
3832
3833The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3834alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3835example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3836sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3837may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3838sections.
3839
3840That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3841
3842@node Simple Commands
3843@section Simple Linker Script Commands
3844@cindex linker script simple commands
3845In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3846
3847@menu
3848* Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3849* File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3850@ifclear SingleFormat
3851* Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3852@end ifclear
3853
4a93e180 3854* REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
252b5132
RH
3855* Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3856@end menu
3857
3858@node Entry Point
36f63dca 3859@subsection Setting the Entry Point
252b5132
RH
3860@kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3861@cindex start of execution
3862@cindex first instruction
3863@cindex entry point
3864The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3865point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3866entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
3867@smallexample
3868ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3869@end smallexample
3870
3871There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
3872entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3873stopping when one of them succeeds:
3874@itemize @bullet
a1ab1d2a 3875@item
252b5132 3876the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
a1ab1d2a 3877@item
252b5132 3878the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
a1ab1d2a 3879@item
a094d01f 3880the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
8a758655 3881targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3ab904c4 3882check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
a1ab1d2a 3883@item
252b5132 3884the address of the first byte of the @samp{.text} section, if present;
a1ab1d2a 3885@item
252b5132
RH
3886The address @code{0}.
3887@end itemize
3888
3889@node File Commands
36f63dca 3890@subsection Commands Dealing with Files
252b5132
RH
3891@cindex linker script file commands
3892Several linker script commands deal with files.
3893
3894@table @code
3895@item INCLUDE @var{filename}
3896@kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
3897@cindex including a linker script
3898Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
3899be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
ff5dcc92 3900with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
252b5132
RH
390110 levels deep.
3902
4006703d
NS
3903You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
3904@code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
3905
252b5132
RH
3906@item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3907@itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3908@kindex INPUT(@var{files})
3909@cindex input files in linker scripts
3910@cindex input object files in linker scripts
3911@cindex linker script input object files
3912The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
3913in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
3914
3915For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
3916a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
3917then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
3918
3919In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
3920script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
3921
e3f2db7f
AO
3922In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
3923with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
3924located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
16171946
FS
3925for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
3926@code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
3927filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
3928@samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3929
3930If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
3931the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
3932found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
3933not found the linker will search through the archive library search
3934path.
252b5132 3935
ff5dcc92 3936If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
a05a5b64 3937name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
252b5132
RH
3938@samp{-l}.
3939
3940When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
3941files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
3942script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
3943
3944@item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3945@itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3946@kindex GROUP(@var{files})
3947@cindex grouping input files
3948The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
3949files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
3950new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
a05a5b64 3951in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
252b5132 3952
b717d30e
JJ
3953@item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3954@itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3955@kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
3956This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
3957commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
3958as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
3959with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
3960when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
3961@option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
3962and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
3963setting afterwards.
3964
252b5132
RH
3965@item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
3966@kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
b45619c0 3967@cindex output file name in linker script
252b5132
RH
3968The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
3969@code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
3970@samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
a05a5b64 3971Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
252b5132
RH
3972precedence.
3973
3974You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
3975output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
3976
3977@item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3978@kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3979@cindex library search path in linker script
3980@cindex archive search path in linker script
3981@cindex search path in linker script
3982The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
ff5dcc92 3983@command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
252b5132 3984@code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
a05a5b64 3985on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
252b5132 3986are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
a05a5b64 3987the command-line option are searched first.
252b5132
RH
3988
3989@item STARTUP(@var{filename})
3990@kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
3991@cindex first input file
3992The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
3993that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
3994though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
3995when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
3996first file.
3997@end table
3998
3999@ifclear SingleFormat
4000@node Format Commands
36f63dca 4001@subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
252b5132
RH
4002A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
4003
4004@table @code
4005@item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4006@itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
4007@kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4008@cindex output file format in linker script
4009The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
4010output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
024531e2 4011exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 4012(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
252b5132
RH
4013line option takes precedence.
4014
4015You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
a05a5b64 4016formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
252b5132
RH
4017This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
4018desired endianness.
4019
4020If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
4021will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
4022output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
4023used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
4024
4025For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
4026command:
4027@smallexample
4028OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
4029@end smallexample
4030This says that the default format for the output file is
a05a5b64 4031@samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
252b5132
RH
4032option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
4033format.
4034
4035@item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4036@kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4037@cindex input file format in linker script
4038The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
4039files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
4040This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 4041(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
252b5132
RH
4042is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
4043command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
4044@end table
4045@end ifclear
4046
4a93e180
NC
4047@node REGION_ALIAS
4048@subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
4049@kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4050@cindex region alias
4051@cindex region names
4052
4053Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
4054@ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
4055
4056@smallexample
4057REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4058@end smallexample
4059
4060The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
4061memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
4062to memory regions. An example follows.
4063
4064Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
4065memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
4066that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
4067non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
4068access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
4069read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
4070sections:
4071
4072@itemize @bullet
4073@item
4074@code{.text} program code;
4075@item
4076@code{.rodata} read-only data;
4077@item
4078@code{.data} read-write initialized data;
4079@item
4080@code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
4081@end itemize
4082
4083The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
4084part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
4085output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
4086systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
4087@code{C}:
4088@multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
4089@item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
9d5777a3 4090@item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4a93e180
NC
4091@item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
4092@item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
4093@item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
4094@end multitable
4095The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
4096loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
4097the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4098the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4099
4100The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4101includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4102memory layout:
4103@smallexample
4104INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4105
4106SECTIONS
4107 @{
4108 .text :
4109 @{
4110 *(.text)
4111 @} > REGION_TEXT
4112 .rodata :
4113 @{
4114 *(.rodata)
4115 rodata_end = .;
4116 @} > REGION_RODATA
4117 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4118 @{
4119 data_start = .;
4120 *(.data)
4121 @} > REGION_DATA
4122 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4123 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4124 .bss :
4125 @{
4126 *(.bss)
4127 @} > REGION_BSS
4128 @}
4129@end smallexample
4130
4131Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4132regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4133variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4134@table @code
4135@item A
4136Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4137@smallexample
4138MEMORY
4139 @{
4140 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4141 @}
4142
4143REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4144REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4145REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4146REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4147@end smallexample
4148@item B
4149Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4150into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4151@code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4152@smallexample
4153MEMORY
4154 @{
4155 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4156 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4157 @}
4158
4159REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4160REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4161REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4162REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4163@end smallexample
4164@item C
4165Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4166@code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4167initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4168system start into the @code{RAM}.
4169@smallexample
4170MEMORY
4171 @{
4172 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4173 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4174 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4175 @}
4176
4177REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4178REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4179REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4180REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4181@end smallexample
4182@end table
4183
4184It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4185@code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4186necessary:
4187@smallexample
4188#include <string.h>
4189
4190extern char data_start [];
4191extern char data_size [];
4192extern char data_load_start [];
4193
4194void copy_data(void)
4195@{
4196 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4197 @{
4198 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4199 @}
4200@}
4201@end smallexample
4202
252b5132 4203@node Miscellaneous Commands
36f63dca 4204@subsection Other Linker Script Commands
252b5132
RH
4205There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4206
4207@table @code
4208@item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4209@kindex ASSERT
4210@cindex assertion in linker script
4211Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4212with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4213
fd1c4238
NC
4214Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4215take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4216inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4217for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4218symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4219
4220@smallexample
4221 .stack :
4222 @{
4223 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4224 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4225 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4226 @}
4227@end smallexample
4228
4229will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4230PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4231can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4232
4233@smallexample
4234 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4235 .stack :
4236 @{
4237 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4238 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4239 @}
4240@end smallexample
4241
4242will work.
4243
252b5132
RH
4244@item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4245@kindex EXTERN
4246@cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4247Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4248symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4249modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4250each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4251command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4252
4253@item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4254@kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4255@cindex common allocation in linker script
4256This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
ff5dcc92 4257to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
252b5132
RH
4258output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4259
4818e05f
AM
4260@item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4261@kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4262@cindex common allocation in linker script
4263This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4264command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4265to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4266
7bdf4127
AB
4267@item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4268@kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4269@cindex group allocation in linker script
4270@cindex section groups
4271@cindex COMDAT
4272This command has the same effect as the
4273@samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4274@command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4275and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4276specified (@samp{-r}).
4277
53d25da6
AM
4278@item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4279@kindex INSERT
4280@cindex insert user script into default script
4281This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4282augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4283inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4284@var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4285default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4286sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4287linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4288insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4289linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4290default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4291of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4292to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4293is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4294
4295@smallexample
4296SECTIONS
4297@{
4298 OVERLAY :
4299 @{
4300 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4301 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4302 @}
4303@}
4304INSERT AFTER .text;
4305@end smallexample
4306
252b5132
RH
4307@item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4308@kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4309@cindex cross references
ff5dcc92 4310This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
252b5132
RH
4311references among certain output sections.
4312
4313In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4314using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4315will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4316errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4317a function defined in the other section.
4318
4319The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
ff5dcc92 4320@command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
252b5132
RH
4321an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4322@code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4323names.
4324
cdf96953
MF
4325@item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4326@kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4327@cindex cross references
4328This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4329references to one section from a list of other sections.
4330
4331The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4332output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4333a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4334there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4335must never call back.
4336
4337The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4338The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4339If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4340the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4341status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4342names, not input section names.
4343
252b5132
RH
4344@ifclear SingleFormat
4345@item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4346@kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4347@cindex machine architecture
4348@cindex architecture
4349Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4350of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4351architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4352the @samp{-f} option.
4353@end ifclear
01554a74
AM
4354
4355@item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4356@kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4357This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4358@var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4359in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4360@xref{Expression Section}.
252b5132
RH
4361@end table
4362
4363@node Assignments
4364@section Assigning Values to Symbols
4365@cindex assignment in scripts
4366@cindex symbol definition, scripts
4367@cindex variables, defining
4368You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
73ae6183 4369the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
252b5132
RH
4370
4371@menu
4372* Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
eb8476a6 4373* HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
252b5132 4374* PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
7af8e998 4375* PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
73ae6183 4376* Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
252b5132
RH
4377@end menu
4378
4379@node Simple Assignments
4380@subsection Simple Assignments
4381
4382You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4383
4384@table @code
4385@item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4386@itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4387@itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4388@itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4389@itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4390@itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4391@itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4392@itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4393@itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4394@end table
4395
4396The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4397@var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4398defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4399
4400The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
b5666f2f 4401may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
252b5132
RH
4402
4403The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4404
4405Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4406
4407You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4408statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4409section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4410
4411The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4412expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4413
4414Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4415assignments may be used:
4416
4417@smallexample
4418floating_point = 0;
4419SECTIONS
4420@{
4421 .text :
4422 @{
4423 *(.text)
4424 _etext = .;
4425 @}
156e34dd 4426 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
252b5132
RH
4427 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4428@}
4429@end smallexample
4430@noindent
4431In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4432zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4433the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4434defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4435upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4436
eb8476a6
MR
4437@node HIDDEN
4438@subsection HIDDEN
4439@cindex HIDDEN
4440For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4441exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4442
4443Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4444@code{HIDDEN}:
4445
4446@smallexample
4447HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4448SECTIONS
4449@{
4450 .text :
4451 @{
4452 *(.text)
4453 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4454 @}
4455 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4456 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4457@}
4458@end smallexample
4459@noindent
4460In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4461
252b5132
RH
4462@node PROVIDE
4463@subsection PROVIDE
4464@cindex PROVIDE
4465In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4466only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4467the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4468@samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4469@samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4470@code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4471@samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4472@code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4473
4474Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4475@smallexample
4476SECTIONS
4477@{
4478 .text :
4479 @{
4480 *(.text)
4481 _etext = .;
4482 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4483 @}
4484@}
4485@end smallexample
4486
4487In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
3c27360b
JB
4488underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition diagnostic. If,
4489on the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
252b5132
RH
4490underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4491If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4492linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4493
b0daac83
NC
4494Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4495defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4496that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4497when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4498@samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4499
7af8e998
L
4500@node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4501@subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4502@cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4503Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4504hidden and won't be exported.
4505
73ae6183
NC
4506@node Source Code Reference
4507@subsection Source Code Reference
4508
4509Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4510intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4511a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4512symbol that does not have a value.
4513
4514Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4515transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4516stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4517prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4518mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4519of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4520variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4521linker script variable might be referred to as:
4522
4523@smallexample
4524 extern int foo;
4525@end smallexample
4526
4527But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4528
4529@smallexample
4530 _foo = 1000;
4531@end smallexample
4532
4533In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4534transformation has taken place.
4535
4536When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4537things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4538in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4539second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4540table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4541contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4542value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4543
4544@smallexample
4545 int foo = 1000;
4546@end smallexample
4547
10bf6894 4548creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
73ae6183
NC
4549holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4550number 1000 is initially stored.
4551
4552When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4553first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4554memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4555So:
4556
4557@smallexample
4558 foo = 1;
4559@end smallexample
4560
4561looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4562associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4563address. Whereas:
4564
4565@smallexample
4566 int * a = & foo;
4567@end smallexample
4568
10bf6894 4569looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
73ae6183
NC
4570and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4571the variable @samp{a}.
4572
4573Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4574the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4575an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4576
4577@smallexample
4578 foo = 1000;
4579@end smallexample
4580
4581creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4582the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4583address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4584linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4585access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4586
4587Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4588you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4589use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4590section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4591linker script contains these declarations:
4592
4593@smallexample
4594@group
4595 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
a5e406b5 4596 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
73ae6183
NC
4597 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4598@end group
4599@end smallexample
4600
4601Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4602
4603@smallexample
4604@group
4605 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
c0065db7 4606
73ae6183
NC
4607 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4608@end group
4609@end smallexample
4610
4611Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
5707d2ad
NC
4612Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4613arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4614
4615@smallexample
4616@group
4617 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4618
4619 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4620@end group
4621@end smallexample
4622
4623Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4624operators.
73ae6183 4625
252b5132 4626@node SECTIONS
36f63dca 4627@section SECTIONS Command
252b5132
RH
4628@kindex SECTIONS
4629The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4630into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4631
4632The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4633@smallexample
4634SECTIONS
4635@{
4636 @var{sections-command}
4637 @var{sections-command}
4638 @dots{}
4639@}
4640@end smallexample
4641
4642Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4643
4644@itemize @bullet
4645@item
4646an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4647@item
4648a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4649@item
4650an output section description
4651@item
4652an overlay description
4653@end itemize
4654
4655The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4656@code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4657those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4658understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4659the layout of the output file.
4660
4661Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4662below.
4663
4664If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4665linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4666section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4667input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4668example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4669in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4670
4671@menu
4672* Output Section Description:: Output section description
4673* Output Section Name:: Output section name
4674* Output Section Address:: Output section address
4675* Input Section:: Input section description
4676* Output Section Data:: Output section data
4677* Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4678* Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4679* Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4680* Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4681@end menu
4682
4683@node Output Section Description
36f63dca 4684@subsection Output Section Description
252b5132
RH
4685The full description of an output section looks like this:
4686@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 4687@group
7e7d5768 4688@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 4689 [AT(@var{lma})]
1eec346e 4690 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
4691 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4692 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
4693 @{
4694 @var{output-section-command}
4695 @var{output-section-command}
4696 @dots{}
abc9061b 4697 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
252b5132
RH
4698@end group
4699@end smallexample
4700
4701Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4702
4703The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4704name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
abc9061b
CC
4705The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4706the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
252b5132
RH
4707The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4708
4709Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4710
4711@itemize @bullet
4712@item
4713a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4714@item
4715an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4716@item
4717data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4718@item
4719a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4720@end itemize
4721
4722@node Output Section Name
36f63dca 4723@subsection Output Section Name
252b5132
RH
4724@cindex name, section
4725@cindex section name
4726The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4727meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4728support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4729must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4730example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4731output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4732names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4733quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4734characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4735commas must be quoted.
4736
4737The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4738Discarding}.
4739
4740@node Output Section Address
2a16d82a 4741@subsection Output Section Address
252b5132
RH
4742@cindex address, section
4743@cindex section address
4744The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
ea5cae92
NC
4745address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4746is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4747
4748If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4749section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4750to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4751alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4752contained within the output section.
4753
4754The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4755
4756@itemize @bullet
4757@item
4758If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4759is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4760in that region.
4761
4762@item
4763If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4764regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4765section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4766be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4767
4768@item
4769If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4770the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4771counter.
4772@end itemize
4773
4774@noindent
4775For example:
4776
252b5132
RH
4777@smallexample
4778.text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4779@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4780
252b5132
RH
4781@noindent
4782and
ea5cae92 4783
252b5132
RH
4784@smallexample
4785.text : @{ *(.text) @}
4786@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4787
252b5132
RH
4788@noindent
4789are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4790@samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4791counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
ea5cae92
NC
4792counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4793input sections.
252b5132
RH
4794
4795The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4796For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4797so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4798do something like this:
4799@smallexample
4800.text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4801@end smallexample
4802@noindent
4803This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4804aligned upward to the specified value.
4805
4806Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
6ce340f1
NC
4807location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4808sections are ignored).
252b5132
RH
4809
4810@node Input Section
36f63dca 4811@subsection Input Section Description
252b5132
RH
4812@cindex input sections
4813@cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4814The most common output section command is an input section description.
4815
4816The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4817You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4818in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4819map the input files into your memory layout.
4820
4821@menu
4822* Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4823* Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4824* Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4825* Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4826* Input Section Example:: Input section example
4827@end menu
4828
4829@node Input Section Basics
36f63dca 4830@subsubsection Input Section Basics
252b5132
RH
4831@cindex input section basics
4832An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4833by a list of section names in parentheses.
4834
4835The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4836describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4837
4838The most common input section description is to include all input
4839sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4840include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4841@smallexample
4842*(.text)
4843@end smallexample
4844@noindent
18625d54 4845Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
8f1732fc 4846@cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
18625d54
CM
4847of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4848match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4849example:
252b5132 4850@smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4851EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4852@end smallexample
4853@noindent
4854will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4855and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4856placed inside the section list, for example:
4857@smallexample
b4346c09 4858*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
252b5132 4859@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4860@noindent
4861The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
4862two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4863more than one section, as described below.
252b5132
RH
4864
4865There are two ways to include more than one section:
4866@smallexample
4867*(.text .rdata)
4868*(.text) *(.rdata)
4869@end smallexample
4870@noindent
4871The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4872@samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
b6bf44ba
AM
4873first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4874they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
252b5132
RH
4875@samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4876@samp{.rdata} input sections.
4877
8f1732fc
AB
4878When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4879is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4880immediately following section, for example:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4881@smallexample
4882*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4883@end smallexample
4884@noindent
4885will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4886@file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4887from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
4888exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
8f1732fc 4889could be modified to:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4890@smallexample
4891*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
4892@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4893@noindent
4894Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
4895before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
4896all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
4897@smallexample
4898EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
4899@end smallexample
a5bf7d4f 4900
252b5132
RH
4901You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
4902You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
4903needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
4904@smallexample
4905data.o(.data)
4906@end smallexample
4907
ae17ab41
CM
4908To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
4909of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
4910
4911Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
4912
4913@smallexample
4914@group
4915SECTIONS @{
4916 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
4917 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
4918@}
4919@end group
4920@end smallexample
4921
4922In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
4923input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
4924@code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
4925@samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
4926whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
4927
967928e9
AM
4928You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
4929matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
4930with no whitespace around the colon.
4931
4932@table @samp
4933@item archive:file
4934matches file within archive
4935@item archive:
4936matches the whole archive
4937@item :file
4938matches file but not one in an archive
4939@end table
4940
4941Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
4942wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
4943single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
4944@samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
4945within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
4946also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
4947other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
4948from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
4949command.
4950
252b5132
RH
4951If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
4952the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
4953commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
4954@smallexample
4955data.o
4956@end smallexample
4957
967928e9
AM
4958When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
4959and does not contain any wild card
252b5132
RH
4960characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
4961name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
4962did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
4963though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
4964@code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
4965the archive search path.
4966
4967@node Input Section Wildcards
36f63dca 4968@subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
252b5132
RH
4969@cindex input section wildcards
4970@cindex wildcard file name patterns
4971@cindex file name wildcard patterns
4972@cindex section name wildcard patterns
4973In an input section description, either the file name or the section
4974name or both may be wildcard patterns.
4975
4976The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
4977pattern for the file name.
4978
4979The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
4980
4981@table @samp
4982@item *
4983matches any number of characters
4984@item ?
4985matches any single character
4986@item [@var{chars}]
4987matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
4988character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
4989@samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
4990@item \
4991quotes the following character
4992@end table
4993
4994When a file name is matched with a wildcard, the wildcard characters
4995will not match a @samp{/} character (used to separate directory names on
4996Unix). A pattern consisting of a single @samp{*} character is an
4997exception; it will always match any file name, whether it contains a
4998@samp{/} or not. In a section name, the wildcard characters will match
4999a @samp{/} character.
5000
5001File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
5002specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
5003does not search directories to expand wildcards.
5004
5005If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
5006appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
5007will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
5008sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
5009@file{data.o} rule will not be used:
5010@smallexample
5011.data : @{ *(.data) @}
5012.data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
5013@end smallexample
5014
bcaa7b3e 5015@cindex SORT_BY_NAME
252b5132
RH
5016Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
5017in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
bcaa7b3e
L
5018this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
5019pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
5020@code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
252b5132
RH
5021into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
5022
bcaa7b3e 5023@cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
9a24a276
AM
5024@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5025@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
5026alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
5027alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
5028needed.
bcaa7b3e 5029
02ecc8e9 5030@cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
9a24a276
AM
5031@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5032@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
5033numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
5034section name before placing them in the output file. In
5035@code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
5036the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
5037@code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
02ecc8e9 5038
bcaa7b3e
L
5039@cindex SORT
5040@code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5041
5042When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
5043can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
5044
5045@enumerate
5046@item
5047@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5048It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5049sections have the same name.
5050@item
5051@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5052It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5053sections have the same alignment.
5054@item
c0065db7 5055@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
bcaa7b3e
L
5056treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
5057@item
5058@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
5059is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
5060@item
5061All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
5062@end enumerate
5063
a05a5b64 5064When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
bcaa7b3e 5065section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
a05a5b64 5066takes precedence over the command-line option.
bcaa7b3e
L
5067
5068If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
a05a5b64 5069command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
bcaa7b3e
L
5070treated as nested sorting command.
5071
5072@enumerate
5073@item
5074@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
5075@option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
5076@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5077@item
5078@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
5079@option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
5080@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5081@end enumerate
5082
5083If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
a05a5b64 5084command-line option will be ignored.
bcaa7b3e 5085
eda680f8 5086@cindex SORT_NONE
a05a5b64 5087@code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
eda680f8
L
5088section sorting option.
5089
252b5132
RH
5090If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
5091@samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
5092precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
5093
5094This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
5095files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
5096sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5097The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5098with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5099linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5100@smallexample
5101@group
5102SECTIONS @{
5103 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5104 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5105 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5106 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5107@}
5108@end group
5109@end smallexample
5110
5111@node Input Section Common
36f63dca 5112@subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
252b5132
RH
5113@cindex common symbol placement
5114@cindex uninitialized data placement
5115A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5116file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5117linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5118named @samp{COMMON}.
5119
5120You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5121other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5122particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5123input files are placed in another section.
5124
5125In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5126@samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5127@smallexample
5128.bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5129@end smallexample
5130
5131@cindex scommon section
5132@cindex small common symbols
5133Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5134example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5135symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5136different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5137the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5138symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5139to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5140locations.
5141
5142@cindex [COMMON]
5143You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5144notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5145@samp{*(COMMON)}.
5146
5147@node Input Section Keep
36f63dca 5148@subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
252b5132
RH
5149@cindex KEEP
5150@cindex garbage collection
5151When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
a1ab1d2a 5152it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
252b5132
RH
5153This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5154with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
bcaa7b3e 5155@code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
252b5132
RH
5156
5157@node Input Section Example
36f63dca 5158@subsubsection Input Section Example
252b5132
RH
5159The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5160to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5161start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5162@samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5163follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5164@samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5165@samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5166All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5167files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5168
5169@smallexample
5170@group
5171SECTIONS @{
5172 outputa 0x10000 :
5173 @{
5174 all.o
5175 foo.o (.input1)
5176 @}
36f63dca
NC
5177@end group
5178@group
252b5132
RH
5179 outputb :
5180 @{
5181 foo.o (.input2)
5182 foo1.o (.input1)
5183 @}
36f63dca
NC
5184@end group
5185@group
252b5132
RH
5186 outputc :
5187 @{
5188 *(.input1)
5189 *(.input2)
5190 @}
5191@}
5192@end group
a1ab1d2a 5193@end smallexample
252b5132 5194
cbd0eecf
L
5195If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5196and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5197automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5198__stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5199indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5200respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5201C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5202
252b5132 5203@node Output Section Data
36f63dca 5204@subsection Output Section Data
252b5132
RH
5205@cindex data
5206@cindex section data
5207@cindex output section data
5208@kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5209@kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5210@kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5211@kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5212@kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5213You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5214@code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5215an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5216parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5217value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5218counter.
5219
5220The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5221store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5222bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5223stored.
5224
5225For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5226of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5227@smallexample
5228BYTE(1)
5229LONG(addr)
5230@end smallexample
5231
5232When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5233same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5234target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5235@code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5236@code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5237
5238If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5239which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5240When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5241true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5242endianness of the first input object file.
5243
36f63dca 5244Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
2b5fc1f5
NC
5245between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5246@smallexample
5247SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5248@end smallexample
5249whereas this will work:
5250@smallexample
5251SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5252@end smallexample
5253
252b5132
RH
5254@kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5255@cindex holes, filling
5256@cindex unspecified memory
5257You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5258current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5259otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5260gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
a139d329 5261with the value of the expression, repeated as
252b5132
RH
5262necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5263point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5264than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5265different parts of an output section.
5266
5267This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
563e308f 5268value @samp{0x90}:
252b5132 5269@smallexample
563e308f 5270FILL(0x90909090)
252b5132
RH
5271@end smallexample
5272
5273The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
9673c93c 5274section attribute, but it only affects the
252b5132
RH
5275part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5276entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
9673c93c 5277precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
a139d329 5278expression.
252b5132
RH
5279
5280@node Output Section Keywords
36f63dca 5281@subsection Output Section Keywords
252b5132
RH
5282There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5283commands.
5284
5285@table @code
5286@kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5287@cindex input filename symbols
5288@cindex filename symbols
5289@item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5290The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5291The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5292file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5293the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5294
5295This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5296normally used for any other object file format.
5297
5298@kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5299@cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5300@cindex constructors, arranging in link
5301@item CONSTRUCTORS
5302When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5303unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5304destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5305arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5306automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5307For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5308linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5309@code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5310ignored for other object file formats.
5311
5312The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
7e69709c
AM
5313constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5314Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5315the start and end of the global destructors. The
252b5132
RH
5316first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5317of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5318compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5319formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5320@code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5321the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5322destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5323@code{exit}.
5324
5325For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5326arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5327addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5328and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5329linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5330runtime code expects to see.
5331
5332@smallexample
5333 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5334 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5335 *(.ctors)
5336 LONG(0)
5337 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5338 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5339 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5340 *(.dtors)
5341 LONG(0)
5342 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5343@end smallexample
5344
5345If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5346which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5347are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5348are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
bcaa7b3e
L
5349command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5350@code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5351@samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
252b5132
RH
5352@samp{*(.dtors)}.
5353
5354Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5355and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5356need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5357scripts.
5358
5359@end table
5360
5361@node Output Section Discarding
36f63dca 5362@subsection Output Section Discarding
252b5132
RH
5363@cindex discarding sections
5364@cindex sections, discarding
5365@cindex removing sections
2edab91c
AM
5366The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5367This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5368may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
252b5132 5369@smallexample
49c13adb 5370.foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
252b5132
RH
5371@end smallexample
5372@noindent
5373will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
74541ad4
AM
5374@samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5375sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
2edab91c
AM
5376space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5377too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5378space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5379@samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5380@samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5381This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
74541ad4 5382
a0976ea4 5383The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
74541ad4
AM
5384on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5385symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
a0976ea4
AM
5386the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5387section is discarded.
252b5132
RH
5388
5389@cindex /DISCARD/
5390The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5391input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5392section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5393
99fabbc9
JL
5394This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5395@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5396garbage collection.
5397
a2e098c3
NC
5398Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5399discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5400members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5401Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5402
252b5132 5403@node Output Section Attributes
36f63dca 5404@subsection Output Section Attributes
252b5132
RH
5405@cindex output section attributes
5406We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5407like this:
0c71d759 5408
252b5132 5409@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 5410@group
7e7d5768 5411@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 5412 [AT(@var{lma})]
3bbec4bd 5413 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
5414 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5415 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
5416 @{
5417 @var{output-section-command}
5418 @var{output-section-command}
5419 @dots{}
562d3460 5420 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
252b5132
RH
5421@end group
5422@end smallexample
0c71d759 5423
252b5132
RH
5424We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5425@var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5426remaining section attributes.
5427
a1ab1d2a 5428@menu
252b5132
RH
5429* Output Section Type:: Output section type
5430* Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
bbf115d3 5431* Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
7e7d5768 5432* Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
0c71d759 5433* Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
252b5132
RH
5434* Output Section Region:: Output section region
5435* Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5436* Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5437@end menu
5438
5439@node Output Section Type
36f63dca 5440@subsubsection Output Section Type
252b5132
RH
5441Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5442parentheses. The following types are defined:
5443
5444@table @code
5445@item NOLOAD
5446The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5447loaded into memory when the program is run.
5448@item DSECT
5449@itemx COPY
5450@itemx INFO
5451@itemx OVERLAY
5452These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5453rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5454marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5455section when the program is run.
5456@end table
5457
5458@kindex NOLOAD
5459@cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5460@cindex loading, preventing
5461The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5462the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5463the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5464@samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
2e76e85a 5465need to be loaded when the program is run.
252b5132
RH
5466@smallexample
5467@group
5468SECTIONS @{
5469 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5470 @dots{}
5471@}
5472@end group
5473@end smallexample
5474
5475@node Output Section LMA
36f63dca 5476@subsubsection Output Section LMA
562d3460 5477@kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
252b5132
RH
5478@kindex AT(@var{lma})
5479@cindex load address
5480@cindex section load address
5481Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
ea5cae92
NC
5482@ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5483@pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5484specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5485address is optional.
6bdafbeb 5486
ea5cae92
NC
5487The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5488specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5489takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5490load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5491region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
dc0b6aa0
AM
5492
5493If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
ea5cae92
NC
5494section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5495load address:
5496
5497@itemize @bullet
5498@item
5499If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5500the LMA address as well.
5501
5502@item
5503If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5504
5505@item
5506Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5507with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5508section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5509VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5510the last section in the located region.
5511
5512@item
5513If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5514that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5515
5516@item
5517If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5518section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5519@end itemize
252b5132
RH
5520
5521@cindex ROM initialized data
5522@cindex initialized data in ROM
5523This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5524example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5525called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5526@samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5527even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5528uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5529defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5530counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5531
5532@smallexample
5533@group
5534SECTIONS
5535 @{
5536 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
a1ab1d2a 5537 .mdata 0x2000 :
252b5132
RH
5538 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5539 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5540 .bss 0x3000 :
5541 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5542@}
5543@end group
5544@end smallexample
5545
5546The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5547this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5548the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5549how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5550script.
5551
5552@smallexample
5553@group
5554extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5555char *src = &_etext;
5556char *dst = &_data;
5557
ea5cae92
NC
5558/* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5559while (dst < &_edata)
252b5132 5560 *dst++ = *src++;
252b5132 5561
ea5cae92 5562/* Zero bss. */
252b5132
RH
5563for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5564 *dst = 0;
5565@end group
5566@end smallexample
5567
bbf115d3
L
5568@node Forced Output Alignment
5569@subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5570@kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5571@cindex forcing output section alignment
5572@cindex output section alignment
1eec346e 5573You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
13075d04
SH
5574alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5575intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
bbf115d3 5576
7e7d5768
AM
5577@node Forced Input Alignment
5578@subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5579@kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5580@cindex forcing input section alignment
5581@cindex input section alignment
5582You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5583SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5584sections, whether larger or smaller.
5585
0c71d759
NC
5586@node Output Section Constraint
5587@subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5588@kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5589@kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5590@cindex constraints on output sections
5591You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5592of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5593read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5594@code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5595
252b5132 5596@node Output Section Region
36f63dca 5597@subsubsection Output Section Region
252b5132
RH
5598@kindex >@var{region}
5599@cindex section, assigning to memory region
5600@cindex memory regions and sections
5601You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5602using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5603
5604Here is a simple example:
5605@smallexample
5606@group
5607MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5608SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5609@end group
5610@end smallexample
5611
5612@node Output Section Phdr
36f63dca 5613@subsubsection Output Section Phdr
252b5132
RH
5614@kindex :@var{phdr}
5615@cindex section, assigning to program header
5616@cindex program headers and sections
5617You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5618using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5619one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5620assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5621@code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5622linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5623
5624Here is a simple example:
5625@smallexample
5626@group
5627PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5628SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5629@end group
5630@end smallexample
5631
5632@node Output Section Fill
36f63dca 5633@subsubsection Output Section Fill
252b5132
RH
5634@kindex =@var{fillexp}
5635@cindex section fill pattern
5636@cindex fill pattern, entire section
5637You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5638@samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5639(@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5640within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
a139d329
AM
5641alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5642necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
9673c93c 5643of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
a139d329
AM
5644an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5645fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
9673c93c 5646other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
a139d329
AM
5647pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5648expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
252b5132
RH
5649
5650You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
9673c93c 5651output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
252b5132
RH
5652
5653Here is a simple example:
5654@smallexample
5655@group
563e308f 5656SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
252b5132
RH
5657@end group
5658@end smallexample
5659
5660@node Overlay Description
36f63dca 5661@subsection Overlay Description
252b5132
RH
5662@kindex OVERLAY
5663@cindex overlays
5664An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5665are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5666the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5667copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5668required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5669can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5670than another.
5671
5672Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5673@code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5674output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5675command is as follows:
5676@smallexample
5677@group
5678OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5679 @{
5680 @var{secname1}
5681 @{
5682 @var{output-section-command}
5683 @var{output-section-command}
5684 @dots{}
5685 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5686 @var{secname2}
5687 @{
5688 @var{output-section-command}
5689 @var{output-section-command}
5690 @dots{}
5691 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5692 @dots{}
abc9061b 5693 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
252b5132
RH
5694@end group
5695@end smallexample
5696
5697Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5698section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5699section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
11e7fd74 5700those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
252b5132
RH
5701except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5702sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5703
abc9061b
CC
5704The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5705the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5706
252b5132
RH
5707The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5708addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5709memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5710whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5711and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5712and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5713
56dd11f0
NC
5714If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5715references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5716the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5717sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5718@xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
252b5132
RH
5719
5720For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
34711ca3 5721provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
252b5132
RH
5722defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5723@code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5724the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5725within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5726symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5727
5728At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5729the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5730
5731Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5732@code{SECTIONS} construct.
5733@smallexample
5734@group
5735 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5736 @{
5737 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5738 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5739 @}
5740@end group
5741@end smallexample
5742@noindent
5743This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5744address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5745@samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
34711ca3 5746following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
252b5132
RH
5747@code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5748@code{__load_stop_text1}.
5749
5750C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5751like the following.
5752
5753@smallexample
5754@group
5755 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5756 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5757 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5758@end group
5759@end smallexample
5760
5761Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5762everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5763example could have been written identically as follows.
5764
5765@smallexample
5766@group
5767 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5768 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5769 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
252b5132 5770 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5771 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5772 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
252b5132
RH
5773 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5774@end group
5775@end smallexample
5776
5777@node MEMORY
36f63dca 5778@section MEMORY Command
252b5132
RH
5779@kindex MEMORY
5780@cindex memory regions
5781@cindex regions of memory
5782@cindex allocating memory
5783@cindex discontinuous memory
5784The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5785memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5786
5787The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5788memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5789may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5790can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5791set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5792regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5793around to fit into the available regions.
5794
127fcdff
AB
5795A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5796however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5797specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5798@code{MEMORY} is:
252b5132
RH
5799@smallexample
5800@group
a1ab1d2a 5801MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5802 @{
5803 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5804 @dots{}
5805 @}
5806@end group
5807@end smallexample
5808
5809The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5810region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5811Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5812with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
4a93e180
NC
5813must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
5814add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
9d5777a3 5815command.
252b5132
RH
5816
5817@cindex memory region attributes
5818The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5819whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5820not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
5821@ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5822section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5823the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5824them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5825
5826The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5827@table @samp
5828@item R
5829Read-only section
5830@item W
5831Read/write section
5832@item X
5833Executable section
5834@item A
5835Allocatable section
5836@item I
5837Initialized section
5838@item L
5839Same as @samp{I}
5840@item !
c09e9a8c 5841Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
252b5132
RH
5842@end table
5843
81c688d5 5844If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
252b5132 5845@samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
81c688d5
NC
5846attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5847unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
5848not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
5849string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
5850or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
5851the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
252b5132
RH
5852
5853@kindex ORIGIN =
5854@kindex o =
5855@kindex org =
9cd6d51a
NC
5856The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
5857the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
5858cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
5859abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
5860@code{ORG}).
252b5132
RH
5861
5862@kindex LENGTH =
5863@kindex len =
5864@kindex l =
5865The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
5866region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
9cd6d51a
NC
5867be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
5868@code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
252b5132
RH
5869
5870In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
5871available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
5872and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
5873linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
5874is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
5875or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
5876explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
5877region.
5878
5879@smallexample
5880@group
a1ab1d2a 5881MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5882 @{
5883 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
5884 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
5885 @}
5886@end group
5887@end smallexample
5888
5889Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
5890specific output sections into that memory region by using the
5891@samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
5892a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
5893output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
5894was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
5895the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
5896output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
5897region, the linker will issue an error message.
5898
3ec57632 5899It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
c0065db7 5900expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
3ec57632
NC
5901@code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
5902
5903@smallexample
5904@group
c0065db7 5905 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
3ec57632
NC
5906@end group
5907@end smallexample
5908
252b5132
RH
5909@node PHDRS
5910@section PHDRS Command
5911@kindex PHDRS
5912@cindex program headers
5913@cindex ELF program headers
5914@cindex program segments
5915@cindex segments, ELF
5916The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
5917@dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
5918loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
5919program with the @samp{-p} option.
5920
5921When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
5922reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
5923program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
5924This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
5925interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
5926
5927The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
5928in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
5929precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
5930the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
5931not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
5932
5933The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
5934generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
5935ignore @code{PHDRS}.
5936
5937This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
5938@code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
5939
5940@smallexample
5941@group
5942PHDRS
5943@{
5944 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
5945 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
5946@}
5947@end group
5948@end smallexample
5949
5950The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
5951of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
5952header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5953with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5c1a3f0f
NS
5954must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
5955is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
252b5132
RH
5956
5957Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
5958system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
5959specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
5960sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
5961attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
5962Section Phdr}.
5963
5964It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
5965merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
5966repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
5967contain the section.
5968
5969If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
5970then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
5971not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
5972convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
5973placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
5974default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
5975segment at all.
5976
5977@kindex FILEHDR
5978@kindex PHDRS
5c1a3f0f 5979You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
252b5132
RH
5980the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
5981The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
5982file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
5c1a3f0f 5983include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
4100cea3
AM
5984segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
5985these keywords.
252b5132
RH
5986
5987The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
5988value of the keyword.
5989
5990@table @asis
5991@item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
5992Indicates an unused program header.
5993
5994@item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
5995Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
5996the file.
5997
5998@item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
5999Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
6000
6001@item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
6002Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
6003found.
6004
6005@item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
6006Indicates a segment holding note information.
6007
6008@item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
6009A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
6010ABI.
6011
6012@item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
6013Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
6014
1a9ccd70
NC
6015@item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
6016Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
6017
252b5132
RH
6018@item @var{expression}
6019An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
6020be used for types not defined above.
6021@end table
6022
6023You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
6024in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
6025@code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
6026Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
6027output section attribute.
6028
6029The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
6030which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
6031explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
6032an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
6033header.
6034
6035Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
6036headers used on a native ELF system.
6037
6038@example
6039@group
6040PHDRS
6041@{
6042 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
6043 interp PT_INTERP ;
6044 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
6045 data PT_LOAD ;
6046 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
6047@}
6048
6049SECTIONS
6050@{
6051 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
6052 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
6053 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
6054 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
6055 @dots{}
6056 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
6057 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
6058 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
6059 @dots{}
6060@}
6061@end group
6062@end example
6063
6064@node VERSION
6065@section VERSION Command
6066@kindex VERSION @{script text@}
6067@cindex symbol versions
6068@cindex version script
6069@cindex versions of symbols
6070The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
6071only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
6072symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
6073a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
6074shared library.
6075
6076You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
6077you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
6078also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
6079
6080The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
6081@smallexample
6082VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
6083@end smallexample
6084
6085The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
6086Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
6087version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
6088version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
6089version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
6090scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
6091library.
6092
6093The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
6094examples.
6095
6096@smallexample
6097VERS_1.1 @{
6098 global:
6099 foo1;
6100 local:
a1ab1d2a
UD
6101 old*;
6102 original*;
6103 new*;
252b5132
RH
6104@};
6105
6106VERS_1.2 @{
6107 foo2;
6108@} VERS_1.1;
6109
6110VERS_2.0 @{
6111 bar1; bar2;
c0065db7 6112 extern "C++" @{
86043bbb 6113 ns::*;
bb1515f2
MF
6114 "f(int, double)";
6115 @};
252b5132
RH
6116@} VERS_1.2;
6117@end smallexample
6118
6119This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6120version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6121The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6122a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
313e35ee
AM
6123of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6124symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6125is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6126in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
86043bbb
MM
6127However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6128name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
252b5132
RH
6129
6130Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6131depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6132to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6133
6134Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6135depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6136and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6137
6138When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6139specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6140unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
a981ed6f 6141unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
ae5a3597
AM
6142somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6143wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6144wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6145set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6146ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
252b5132
RH
6147
6148The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6149they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6150could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6151However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6152
0f6bf451 6153Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6b9b879a
JJ
6154in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6155symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6156won't.
6157
6158@smallexample
7c9c73be 6159@{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
9d201f2f 6160@end smallexample
6b9b879a 6161
252b5132
RH
6162When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6163symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6164requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6165shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6166loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6167linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6168application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6169way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6170all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6171search for each symbol reference.
6172
6173The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6174doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6175that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6176functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6177the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6178required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6179that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6180versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6181the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6182
6183There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6184first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6185source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6186script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6187maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6188@smallexample
6189__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6190@end smallexample
6191@noindent
6192in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6193be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6194The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
96a94295
L
6195@samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6196takes precedence over a version script.
252b5132
RH
6197
6198The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6199function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6200an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6201version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6202linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6203
6204To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6205source file. Here is an example:
6206
6207@smallexample
6208__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6209__asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6210__asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6211__asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6212@end smallexample
6213
6214In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6215unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6216example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6217@samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6218
6219When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6220some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6221this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6222@samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6223declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6224you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6225
6226If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6227within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
36f63dca 6228(i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
252b5132
RH
6229specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6230
cb840a31
L
6231You can also specify the language in the version script:
6232
6233@smallexample
6234VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6235@end smallexample
6236
c0065db7 6237The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
cb840a31
L
6238The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6239demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
bb1515f2
MF
6240patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6241@samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
cb840a31 6242
86043bbb
MM
6243Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6244described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6245or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6246the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6247whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6248cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6249might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6250should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6251expect when you upgrade.
6252
252b5132
RH
6253@node Expressions
6254@section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6255@cindex expressions
6256@cindex arithmetic
6257The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
6258that of C expressions. All expressions are evaluated as integers. All
6259expressions are evaluated in the same size, which is 32 bits if both the
6260host and target are 32 bits, and is otherwise 64 bits.
6261
6262You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6263
6264The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6265expressions.
6266
6267@menu
6268* Constants:: Constants
0c71d759 6269* Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
252b5132 6270* Symbols:: Symbol Names
ecca9871 6271* Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
252b5132
RH
6272* Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6273* Operators:: Operators
6274* Evaluation:: Evaluation
6275* Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6276* Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6277@end menu
6278
6279@node Constants
6280@subsection Constants
6281@cindex integer notation
6282@cindex constants in linker scripts
6283All constants are integers.
6284
6285As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6286octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
8a308ae8 6287hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
11e7fd74 6288@samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
8a308ae8
NC
6289@samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6290value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
252b5132
RH
6291
6292@cindex scaled integers
6293@cindex K and M integer suffixes
6294@cindex M and K integer suffixes
6295@cindex suffixes for integers
6296@cindex integer suffixes
6297In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6298constant by
6299@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6300@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6301@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6302@code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6303@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6304@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6305@tex
6306${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6307@end tex
6308@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
8a308ae8
NC
6309respectively. For example, the following
6310all refer to the same quantity:
6311
252b5132 6312@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6313_fourk_1 = 4K;
6314_fourk_2 = 4096;
6315_fourk_3 = 0x1000;
8a308ae8 6316_fourk_4 = 10000o;
252b5132
RH
6317@end smallexample
6318
8a308ae8
NC
6319Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6320conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6321
0c71d759
NC
6322@node Symbolic Constants
6323@subsection Symbolic Constants
6324@cindex symbolic constants
6325@kindex CONSTANT
a094d01f 6326It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
0c71d759
NC
6327the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6328
6329@table @code
6330@item MAXPAGESIZE
6331@kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6332The target's maximum page size.
6333
6334@item COMMONPAGESIZE
6335@kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6336The target's default page size.
6337@end table
6338
6339So for example:
6340
6341@smallexample
9d5777a3 6342 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
0c71d759
NC
6343@end smallexample
6344
6345will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6346supported by the target.
6347
252b5132
RH
6348@node Symbols
6349@subsection Symbol Names
6350@cindex symbol names
6351@cindex names
6352@cindex quoted symbol names
6353@kindex "
6354Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6355and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6356Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6357specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6358keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6359@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6360"SECTION" = 9;
6361"with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
252b5132
RH
6362@end smallexample
6363
6364Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6365to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6366whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6367
ecca9871
L
6368@node Orphan Sections
6369@subsection Orphan Sections
6370@cindex orphan
6371Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6372are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6373script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
a87ded7b
AB
6374output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6375in which to place the orphaned input section.
6376
6377If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6378an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6379placed at the end of that output section.
6380
6381If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6382sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6383name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6384orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6385one new output section.
6386
6387If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6388then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
e299b355
AM
6389in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6390linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6391attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6392sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6393support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
ecca9871 6394
a05a5b64
TP
6395The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6396(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
c005eb9e
AB
6397output sections an orphan is placed in.
6398
252b5132
RH
6399@node Location Counter
6400@subsection The Location Counter
6401@kindex .
6402@cindex dot
6403@cindex location counter
6404@cindex current output location
6405The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6406current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6407location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6408within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6409anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6410
6411@cindex holes
6412Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6413moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
dc0b6aa0
AM
6414location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6415and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6416doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
252b5132
RH
6417
6418@smallexample
6419SECTIONS
6420@{
6421 output :
6422 @{
6423 file1(.text)
6424 . = . + 1000;
6425 file2(.text)
6426 . += 1000;
6427 file3(.text)
563e308f 6428 @} = 0x12345678;
252b5132
RH
6429@}
6430@end smallexample
6431@noindent
6432In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6433located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6434followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6435@file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
563e308f 6436@samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
252b5132
RH
6437specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6438
5c6bbab8
NC
6439@cindex dot inside sections
6440Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6441current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
69da35b5 6442statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
5c6bbab8
NC
6443absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6444however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6445not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6446
6447@smallexample
6448SECTIONS
6449@{
6450 . = 0x100
6451 .text: @{
6452 *(.text)
6453 . = 0x200
6454 @}
6455 . = 0x500
6456 .data: @{
6457 *(.data)
6458 . += 0x600
6459 @}
6460@}
6461@end smallexample
6462
6463The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6464and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6465the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6466much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6467move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6468and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6469the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6470the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6471
b5666f2f
AM
6472@cindex dot outside sections
6473Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6474output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6475needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6476
6477@smallexample
6478SECTIONS
6479@{
6480 start_of_text = . ;
6481 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6482 end_of_text = . ;
6483
6484 start_of_data = . ;
6485 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6486 end_of_data = . ;
6487@}
6488@end smallexample
6489
6490If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6491not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6492between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6493should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6494blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6495the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6496sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6497statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6498special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6499place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6500as follows:
6501
6502@smallexample
6503SECTIONS
6504@{
6505 start_of_text = . ;
6506 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6507 end_of_text = . ;
6508
6509 start_of_data = . ;
6510 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6511 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6512 end_of_data = . ;
6513@}
6514@end smallexample
6515
6516This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6517@code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6518placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6519assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6520a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6521section. So you could write:
6522
6523@smallexample
6524SECTIONS
6525@{
6526 start_of_text = . ;
6527 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6528 end_of_text = . ;
6529
6530 . = . ;
6531 start_of_data = . ;
6532 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6533 end_of_data = . ;
6534@}
6535@end smallexample
6536
6537Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6538@code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6539
252b5132
RH
6540@need 2000
6541@node Operators
6542@subsection Operators
6543@cindex operators for arithmetic
6544@cindex arithmetic operators
6545@cindex precedence in expressions
6546The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6547the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6548@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6549@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6550@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6551@smallexample
6552precedence associativity Operators Notes
6553(highest)
65541 left ! - ~ (1)
65552 left * / %
65563 left + -
65574 left >> <<
65585 left == != > < <= >=
65596 left &
65607 left |
65618 left &&
65629 left ||
656310 right ? :
656411 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6565(lowest)
6566@end smallexample
6567Notes:
a1ab1d2a 6568(1) Prefix operators
252b5132
RH
6569(2) @xref{Assignments}.
6570@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6571@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6572@tex
6573\vskip \baselineskip
6574%"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6575\hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6576\hrule
6577\halign
6578{\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6579height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6580&Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6581height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6582\noalign{\hrule}
6583height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6584&highest&&&&&\cr
6585% '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
a1ab1d2a 6586&1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
252b5132
RH
6587&2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6588&3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6589&4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6590&5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6591&6&&left&&\&&\cr
6592&7&&left&&|&\cr
6593&8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6594&9&&left&&||&\cr
6595&10&&right&&? :&\cr
6596&11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6597&lowest&&&&&\cr
6598height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6599\hrule}
6600@end tex
6601@iftex
6602{
6603@obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6604@dag@quad Prefix operators.
6605@ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6606}
6607@end iftex
6608@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6609
6610@node Evaluation
6611@subsection Evaluation
6612@cindex lazy evaluation
6613@cindex expression evaluation order
6614The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6615an expression when absolutely necessary.
6616
6617The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6618address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6619regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6620as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6621
6622However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6623until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6624other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6625for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6626
6627The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6628assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6629allocation.
6630
6631Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6632@samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6633
6634If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6635available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6636following
6637@smallexample
6638@group
6639SECTIONS
6640 @{
a1ab1d2a 6641 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
252b5132
RH
6642 @{ *(.text) @}
6643 @}
6644@end group
6645@end smallexample
6646@noindent
6647will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6648address}.
6649
6650@node Expression Section
6651@subsection The Section of an Expression
6652@cindex expression sections
6653@cindex absolute expressions
6654@cindex relative expressions
6655@cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6656@cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6657@cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
7542af2a
AM
6658Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6659relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6660using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6661value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6662symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6663operations.
6664
abf4be64
AM
6665Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6666section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6667address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6668@code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6669functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
01554a74
AM
6670One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6671(@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
5c3049d2
AM
6672differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6673versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6674section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6675Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
01554a74
AM
6676absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6677given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6678everywhere.
5c3049d2
AM
6679
6680In the following simple example,
252b5132 6681
7542af2a
AM
6682@smallexample
6683@group
6684SECTIONS
6685 @{
6686 . = 0x100;
6687 __executable_start = 0x100;
6688 .data :
6689 @{
6690 . = 0x10;
6691 __data_start = 0x10;
6692 *(.data)
6693 @}
6694 @dots{}
6695 @}
6696@end group
6697@end smallexample
252b5132 6698
7542af2a
AM
6699both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6700address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6701@code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6702section in the second two assignments.
252b5132 6703
5c3049d2
AM
6704For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6705addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
7542af2a
AM
6706
6707@itemize @bullet
6708@item
c05f749e
AM
6709Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6710operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6711absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6712@item
7542af2a
AM
6713Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6714relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6715and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6716@item
c05f749e
AM
6717Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6718in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6719address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6720before applying the operator.
7542af2a
AM
6721@end itemize
6722
6723The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6724
6725@itemize @bullet
6726@item
6727An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6728@item
6729The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6730@item
9bc8bb33 6731The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
11e7fd74 6732relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
94b41882
AM
6733(after above conversions) is also a number when
6734@code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6735but an absolute address otherwise.
9bc8bb33
AM
6736@item
6737The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6738relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6739section as the relative operand(s).
7542af2a
AM
6740@item
6741The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6742conversions) is an absolute address.
6743@end itemize
252b5132
RH
6744
6745You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6746to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6747create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6748section @samp{.data}:
6749@smallexample
6750SECTIONS
6751 @{
6752 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6753 @}
6754@end smallexample
6755@noindent
6756If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6757@samp{.data} section.
6758
7542af2a
AM
6759Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6760particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6761
252b5132
RH
6762@node Builtin Functions
6763@subsection Builtin Functions
6764@cindex functions in expressions
6765The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6766use in linker script expressions.
6767
6768@table @code
6769@item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6770@kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6771@cindex expression, absolute
6772Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6773of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6774value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6775normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6776
6777@item ADDR(@var{section})
6778@kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6779@cindex section address in expression
7542af2a 6780Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
252b5132 6781script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
7542af2a
AM
6782the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6783@code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6784@code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6785the other two will be absolute:
252b5132
RH
6786@smallexample
6787@group
6788SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6789 .output1 :
a1ab1d2a 6790 @{
252b5132
RH
6791 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6792 @dots{}
6793 @}
6794 .output :
6795 @{
6796 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6797 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6798 @}
6799@dots{} @}
6800@end group
6801@end smallexample
6802
876f4090
NS
6803@item ALIGN(@var{align})
6804@itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6805@kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6806@kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
252b5132
RH
6807@cindex round up location counter
6808@cindex align location counter
876f4090
NS
6809@cindex round up expression
6810@cindex align expression
6811Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6812to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6813doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6814arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6815expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
e0a3af22 6816equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
876f4090
NS
6817
6818Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6819next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6820variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6821input sections:
252b5132
RH
6822@smallexample
6823@group
6824SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6825 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6826 *(.data)
6827 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6828 @}
6829@dots{} @}
6830@end group
6831@end smallexample
6832@noindent
6833The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6834a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6835a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
6836of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6837
6838The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6839
362c1d1a
NS
6840@item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6841@kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6842@cindex section alignment
6843Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6844been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6845evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6846the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
6847value in that section.
6848@smallexample
6849@group
6850SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6851 .output @{
6852 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
6853 @dots{}
6854 @}
6855@dots{} @}
6856@end group
6857@end smallexample
6858
252b5132
RH
6859@item BLOCK(@var{exp})
6860@kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
6861This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
6862scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
6863section.
6864
2d20f7bf
JJ
6865@item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6866@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6867This is equivalent to either
6868@smallexample
6869(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
6870@end smallexample
6871or
6872@smallexample
fe6052e1
AM
6873(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
6874 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
2d20f7bf
JJ
6875@end smallexample
6876@noindent
6877depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
6878for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
6879@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
6880If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
6881memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
6882bytes in the on-disk file.
6883
6884This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
6885any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
6886@var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
def5c83c
AM
6887be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
6888running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
6889that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
6890page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
2d20f7bf
JJ
6891
6892@noindent
6893Example:
6894@smallexample
6895 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
6896@end smallexample
6897
6898@item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6899@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6900This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
6901evaluation purposes.
6902
6903@smallexample
6904 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
6905@end smallexample
6906
a4f5ad88
JJ
6907@item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6908@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6909This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
eec2f3ed 6910@samp{-z relro} option is used.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6911When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
6912does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
def5c83c
AM
6913@var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
6914argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
6915script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
eec2f3ed
AM
6916@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
6917padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
6918section alignment.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6919
6920@smallexample
6921 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
6922@end smallexample
6923
252b5132
RH
6924@item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6925@kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6926@cindex symbol defaults
6927Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
420e579c
HPN
6928defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
6929return 0. You can use this function to provide
252b5132
RH
6930default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
6931shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
6932the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
6933existed, its value is preserved:
6934
6935@smallexample
6936@group
6937SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6938 .text : @{
6939 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
6940 @dots{}
6941 @}
6942 @dots{}
6943@}
6944@end group
6945@end smallexample
6946
3ec57632
NC
6947@item LENGTH(@var{memory})
6948@kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
6949Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6950
252b5132
RH
6951@item LOADADDR(@var{section})
6952@kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
6953@cindex section load address in expression
7542af2a 6954Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
252b5132
RH
6955Section LMA}).
6956
2e53f7d6
NC
6957@item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6958@kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6959Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
6960@code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
6961
252b5132
RH
6962@kindex MAX
6963@item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6964Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6965
6966@kindex MIN
6967@item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6968Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6969
6970@item NEXT(@var{exp})
6971@kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
6972@cindex unallocated address, next
6973Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
6974This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
6975use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
6976output file, the two functions are equivalent.
6977
3ec57632
NC
6978@item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6979@kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6980Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6981
ba916c8a
MM
6982@item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6983@kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6984Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
c5da8c7d
NC
6985value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
6986@samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
6987will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
6988can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7542af2a 6989``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
ba916c8a
MM
6990name.
6991
252b5132
RH
6992@item SIZEOF(@var{section})
6993@kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
6994@cindex section size
6995Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6996been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6997evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6998@code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
6999@smallexample
7000@group
7001SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7002 .output @{
7003 .start = . ;
7004 @dots{}
7005 .end = . ;
7006 @}
7007 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
7008 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
7009@dots{} @}
7010@end group
7011@end smallexample
7012
7013@item SIZEOF_HEADERS
7014@itemx sizeof_headers
7015@kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
7016@cindex header size
7017Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
7018information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
7019this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
7020choose, to facilitate paging.
7021
7022@cindex not enough room for program headers
7023@cindex program headers, not enough room
7024When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
7025@code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
7026number of program headers before it has determined all the section
7027addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
7028additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
7029room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
7030the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
7031script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
7032you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
7033command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
7034@end table
7035
7036@node Implicit Linker Scripts
7037@section Implicit Linker Scripts
7038@cindex implicit linker scripts
7039If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
7040an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
7041linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
7042linker will report an error.
7043
7044An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
7045
7046Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
7047assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
7048commands.
7049
7050Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
7051at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
7052read. This can affect archive searching.
7053
bf6d8037
HC
7054@node Plugins
7055@chapter Linker Plugins
7056
7057@cindex plugins
7058@cindex linker plugins
7059The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior.
7060For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers
7061support is implemented with a linker plugin.
7062
7063Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may
7064be added here later.
7065
7066@menu
7067* libdep Plugin:: Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7068@end menu
7069
7070@node libdep Plugin
7071@section Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7072@cindex static library dependencies
7073Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting
7074just of a collection of relocatable object files. Later they evolved to
7075optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects
7076within a library. There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries
7077rose to ascendance.
7078
7079One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting
7080multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their
7081dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic
7082library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly
7083referenced as well. But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a
7084link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static
7085libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to
7086explicitly list the dependencies of the static library.
7087
7088The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option
7089to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep}
7090plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time. The
7091dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l}
7092and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker
7093command line. As such, the information can be written with any text
7094utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not
7095being used to create the archive. The information is stored in an
7096archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}.
7097
7098For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another
7099library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib},
7100the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain
7101
7102@smallexample
7103-L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto
7104@end smallexample
7105
252b5132
RH
7106@ifset GENERIC
7107@node Machine Dependent
7108@chapter Machine Dependent Features
7109
7110@cindex machine dependencies
ff5dcc92
SC
7111@command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
7112sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
252b5132
RH
7113functionality are not listed.
7114
7115@menu
36f63dca
NC
7116@ifset H8300
7117* H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
7118@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
7119@ifset M68HC11
7120* M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7121@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
7122@ifset ARM
7123* ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
7124@end ifset
7125@ifset HPPA
7126* HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
7127@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
7128@ifset M68K
7129* M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7130@end ifset
833794fc
MR
7131@ifset MIPS
7132* MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7133@end ifset
3c3bdf30 7134@ifset MMIX
36f63dca 7135* MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
3c3bdf30 7136@end ifset
2469cfa2 7137@ifset MSP430
36f63dca 7138* MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
2469cfa2 7139@end ifset
35c08157
KLC
7140@ifset NDS32
7141* NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
7142@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
7143@ifset NIOSII
7144* Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7145@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
7146@ifset POWERPC
7147* PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7148@end ifset
7149@ifset POWERPC64
7150* PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7151@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
7152@ifset S/390
7153* S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7154@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
7155@ifset SPU
7156* SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7157@end ifset
74459f0e 7158@ifset TICOFF
ff5dcc92 7159* TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
74459f0e 7160@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
7161@ifset WIN32
7162* WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7163@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
7164@ifset XTENSA
7165* Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7166@end ifset
252b5132
RH
7167@end menu
7168@end ifset
7169
252b5132
RH
7170@ifset H8300
7171@ifclear GENERIC
7172@raisesections
7173@end ifclear
7174
7175@node H8/300
ff5dcc92 7176@section @command{ld} and the H8/300
252b5132
RH
7177
7178@cindex H8/300 support
ff5dcc92 7179For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
252b5132
RH
7180you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7181
7182@table @emph
7183@cindex relaxing on H8/300
7184@item relaxing address modes
ff5dcc92 7185@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
252b5132
RH
7186targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7187program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7188respectively.
7189
7190@cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7191@item synthesizing instructions
81f5558e 7192@c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
ff5dcc92 7193@command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
252b5132
RH
7194sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7195page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7196(That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7197@samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7198top page of memory).
1502569c 7199
81f5558e
NC
7200@command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7201indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7202displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7203the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7204@code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7205whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7206range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7207
1502569c 7208@item bit manipulation instructions
c0065db7 7209@command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
1502569c 7210biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
c0065db7 7211which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
1502569c
NC
7212page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7213(That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
c0065db7 7214@samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c
NC
7215the top page of memory).
7216
7217@item system control instructions
c0065db7
RM
7218@command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
721932 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
1502569c
NC
7220changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7221(That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
c0065db7 7222@samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c 7223the top page of memory).
252b5132
RH
7224@end table
7225
7226@ifclear GENERIC
7227@lowersections
7228@end ifclear
7229@end ifset
7230
36f63dca 7231@ifclear GENERIC
c2dcd04e 7232@ifset Renesas
36f63dca 7233@c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
c2dcd04e
NC
7234@c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7235@node Renesas
7236@chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
36f63dca 7237
c2dcd04e
NC
7238@command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7239H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7240options are required for these chips.
36f63dca
NC
7241@end ifset
7242@end ifclear
7243
36f63dca
NC
7244@ifset ARM
7245@ifclear GENERIC
7246@raisesections
7247@end ifclear
7248
93fd0973
SC
7249@ifset M68HC11
7250@ifclear GENERIC
7251@raisesections
7252@end ifclear
7253
7254@node M68HC11/68HC12
7255@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7256
7257@cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7258
7259@subsection Linker Relaxation
7260
7261For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7262optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7263
7264@table @emph
7265@cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7266@item relaxing address modes
7267@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7268targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7269program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7270respectively.
7271
7272@command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7273transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7274page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7275
7276@item relaxing gcc instruction group
7277When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7278of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7279addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7280@code{bset} instructions.
7281
7282@end table
7283
7284@subsection Trampoline Generation
7285
7286@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7287@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7288For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7289call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
c0065db7 7290will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
93fd0973
SC
7291trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7292case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7293point to the function trampoline.
7294
7295@ifclear GENERIC
7296@lowersections
7297@end ifclear
7298@end ifset
7299
36f63dca 7300@node ARM
3674e28a 7301@section @command{ld} and the ARM family
36f63dca
NC
7302
7303@cindex ARM interworking support
7304@kindex --support-old-code
7305For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
b45619c0 7306between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
36f63dca
NC
7307been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7308line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7309libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
a05a5b64 7310option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
36f63dca
NC
7311given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7312which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7313the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7314non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7315
7316@cindex thumb entry point
7317@cindex entry point, thumb
7318@kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7319The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7320@samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7321But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7322branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7323executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7324
ce11ba6c
KT
7325@cindex PE import table prefixing
7326@kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7327The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7328the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
11e7fd74 7329element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
ce11ba6c
KT
7330import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7331
e489d0ae
PB
7332@cindex BE8
7333@kindex --be8
7334The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
080bb7bb
NC
7335executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7336objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7337option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7338little-endian code.
e489d0ae 7339
3674e28a
PB
7340@cindex TARGET1
7341@kindex --target1-rel
7342@kindex --target1-abs
7343The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7344@samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7345or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7346and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7347
7348@cindex TARGET2
7349@kindex --target2=@var{type}
7350The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7351@samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7352meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7353@table @samp
7354@item rel
eeac373a
PB
7355@samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7356@item abs
a57d1773 7357@samp{R_ARM_ABS32}
3674e28a
PB
7358@item got-rel
7359@samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7360@end table
7361
319850b4
JB
7362@cindex FIX_V4BX
7363@kindex --fix-v4bx
7364The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7365specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7366interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7367also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7368
7369In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7370linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7371@code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7372
7373In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7374relocations are ignored.
7375
845b51d6
PB
7376@cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7377@kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7378Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7379relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7380
7381@smallexample
7382TST rM, #1
7383MOVEQ PC, rM
7384BX Rn
7385@end smallexample
7386
7387This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7388and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
11e7fd74 7389condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
845b51d6 7390
33bfe774
JB
7391@cindex USE_BLX
7392@kindex --use-blx
7393The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7394BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7395situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7396code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7397each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7398
c6dd86c6
JB
7399@cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7400@kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7401The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7402bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7403instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7404to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7405the support code can read the intended values.
7406
7407The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7408intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7409and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7410intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7411full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7412you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7413
7414If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7415enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7416@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7417mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7418vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7419@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7420
7421If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7422potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7423such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7424first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7425instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7426the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7427are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7428
2de70689
MGD
7429@cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7430@kindex --fix-arm1176
7431@kindex --no-fix-arm1176
9d5777a3
RM
7432The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7433in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7434are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
2de70689
MGD
7435unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7436
9d5777a3 7437Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
11e7fd74 7438Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
2de70689
MGD
7439http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7440
a504d23a
LA
7441@cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7442@kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7443
7444The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7445workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7446the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7447off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7448the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7449core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7450integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7451VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7452
7453The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7454necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7455
7456The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7457@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7458STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7459linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7460@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7461
7462If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7463potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7464such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7465replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7466branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7467then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7468
7469The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7470the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7471
7472The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7473they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7474there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7475occurs.
7476
7477The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7478PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7479large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7480cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7481occurs.
7482
bf21ed78
MS
7483@cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7484@kindex --no-enum-size-warning
726150b7 7485The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
bf21ed78
MS
7486warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7487enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7488linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7489using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7490not be diagnosed.
a9dc9481
JM
7491
7492@cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7493@kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7494The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7495warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7496@code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7497linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7498using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
bf21ed78 7499
726150b7
NC
7500@cindex PIC_VENEER
7501@kindex --pic-veneer
7502The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7503ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7504is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7505@samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7506
7507@cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7508@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7509The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7510code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7511perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7512placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
a05a5b64 7513controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
726150b7 7514The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
11e7fd74 7515duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
726150b7
NC
7516group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7517code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7518where they should be placed.
7519
7520The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7521@option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
07d72278 7522placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
726150b7
NC
7523branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7524placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7525value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7526exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7527A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7528linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7529from the input sections.
7530
7531The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7532@samp{N = +1}.
7533
1a51c1a4
NC
7534Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7535only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7536otherwise.
7537
1db37fe6
YG
7538@cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7539@kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7540@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7541The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7542
7543The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7544
68fcca92
JW
7545@cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7546@kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7547@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7548The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7549
7550Please contact ARM for further details.
7551
1db37fe6
YG
7552@kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7553@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7554@cindex Merging exidx entries
7555The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7556
7557@kindex --long-plt
7558@cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7559The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7560which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7561entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7562
1f56df9d
JW
7563@kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7564@cindex AArch64 rela addend
7565The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7566link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7567
4ba2ef8f
TP
7568@cindex Placement of SG veneers
7569All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
a05a5b64 7570Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
4ba2ef8f
TP
7571@samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7572veneers in memory.
7573
54ddd295
TP
7574@kindex --cmse-implib
7575@cindex Secure gateway import library
7576The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7577specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7578secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7579executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7580
0955507f
TP
7581@kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7582@cindex Input import library
7583The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7584must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7585given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7586in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7587@samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7588library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7589library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7590for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7591specified.
7592
36f63dca
NC
7593@ifclear GENERIC
7594@lowersections
7595@end ifclear
7596@end ifset
7597
7598@ifset HPPA
7599@ifclear GENERIC
7600@raisesections
7601@end ifclear
7602
7603@node HPPA ELF32
7604@section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7605@cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7606@kindex --multi-subspace
7607When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7608import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7609The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7610stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7611multiple sub-spaces.
7612
7613@cindex HPPA stub grouping
7614@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7615Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7616stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7617@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7618sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7619a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7620the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7621conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7622prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7623A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7624branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7625@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7626@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7627detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7628positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7629
7630Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7631single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7632create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7633large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7634
7635@ifclear GENERIC
7636@lowersections
7637@end ifclear
7638@end ifset
7639
7fb9f789
NC
7640@ifset M68K
7641@ifclear GENERIC
7642@raisesections
7643@end ifclear
7644
7645@node M68K
7646@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7647
7648@cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7649@kindex --got=@var{type}
7650The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7651The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7652@samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7653the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7654@samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7655entries only at non-negative offsets.
7656@samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7657entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7658support such GOTs.
7659@samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7660output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7661file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7662files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7663
7664@ifclear GENERIC
7665@lowersections
7666@end ifclear
7667@end ifset
7668
833794fc
MR
7669@ifset MIPS
7670@ifclear GENERIC
7671@raisesections
7672@end ifclear
7673
7674@node MIPS
7675@section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7676
7677@cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7678@kindex --insn32
7679@kindex --no-insn32
7680The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7681microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7682in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7683used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7684or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7685including 16-bit ones where possible.
7686
8b10b0b3
MR
7687@cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7688@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7689@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7690The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7691control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7692@samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7693relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7694calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7695relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7696instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7697or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7698the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7699
833794fc
MR
7700@ifclear GENERIC
7701@lowersections
7702@end ifclear
7703@end ifset
7704
36f63dca
NC
7705@ifset MMIX
7706@ifclear GENERIC
7707@raisesections
7708@end ifclear
7709
7710@node MMIX
7711@section @code{ld} and MMIX
7712For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7713@code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7714understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7715can translate between the two formats.
7716
7717There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7718Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7719registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7720equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7721@samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7722global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7723this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7724symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7725
7a2de473
HPN
7726Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7727@code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7728The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7729of a section.
36f63dca
NC
7730
7731Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7732are left out from an mmo file.
7733
7734@ifclear GENERIC
7735@lowersections
7736@end ifclear
7737@end ifset
7738
7739@ifset MSP430
7740@ifclear GENERIC
7741@raisesections
7742@end ifclear
7743
7744@node MSP430
7745@section @code{ld} and MSP430
7746For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7747will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7748just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7749
7750@cindex MSP430 extra sections
7751The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7752
7753@table @code
7754@item @samp{.vectors}
7755Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7756
7757@item @samp{.bootloader}
7758Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7759in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7760
7761@item @samp{.infomem}
7762Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7763this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7764
c0065db7 7765@item @samp{.infomemnobits}
36f63dca
NC
7766This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7767in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7768
7769@item @samp{.noinit}
7770Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7771
c0065db7 7772The last two sections are used by gcc.
36f63dca
NC
7773@end table
7774
7ef3addb
JL
7775@table @option
7776@cindex MSP430 Options
7777@kindex --code-region
7778@item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7779This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7780argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7781using this option.
7782
7783@kindex --data-region
7784@item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7785This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7786[either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7787for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7788
7789@kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7790@item --disable-sec-transformation
7791Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7792and @code{--data-region} options.
7793This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7794wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7795not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7796@end table
7797
36f63dca
NC
7798@ifclear GENERIC
7799@lowersections
7800@end ifclear
7801@end ifset
7802
35c08157
KLC
7803@ifset NDS32
7804@ifclear GENERIC
7805@raisesections
7806@end ifclear
7807
7808@node NDS32
7809@section @code{ld} and NDS32
7810@kindex relaxing on NDS32
7811For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
7812relaxes objects according to these options.
7813
7814@table @code
7815@item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7816Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7817
7818@item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7819Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7820
7821@item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7822Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7823
7824@item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7825Export the EX9 table after linking.
7826
7827@item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7828Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7829
7830@item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7831Update the existing EX9 table.
7832
7833@item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7834Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7835
7836@item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7837Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7838
7839@item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7840Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7841
7842@item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7843Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
7844@end table
7845
7846@ifclear GENERIC
7847@lowersections
7848@end ifclear
7849@end ifset
7850
78058a5e
SL
7851@ifset NIOSII
7852@ifclear GENERIC
7853@raisesections
7854@end ifclear
7855
7856@node Nios II
7857@section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7858@cindex Nios II call relaxation
7859@kindex --relax on Nios II
7860
7861Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
7862transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
7863which may result in @command{ld} giving
7864@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7865The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
7866trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
7867outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
7868trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
7869be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
7870larger than 256MB.
7871
7872The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
7873is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
7874@option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
7875locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
7876source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
7877register as a temporary.
7878
7879Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
7880relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
7881option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
7882
7883@ifclear GENERIC
7884@lowersections
7885@end ifclear
7886@end ifset
7887
2a60a7a8
AM
7888@ifset POWERPC
7889@ifclear GENERIC
7890@raisesections
7891@end ifclear
7892
7893@node PowerPC ELF32
7894@section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7895@cindex PowerPC long branches
7896@kindex --relax on PowerPC
7897Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
7898displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
7899@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7900@samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
7901the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
7902section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
c8a1f254
NS
7903section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
7904@samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
7905both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
7906considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
2a60a7a8
AM
7907
7908@cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
7909@table @option
7910@cindex PowerPC PLT
7911@kindex --bss-plt
7912@item --bss-plt
7913Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
7914generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
7915the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
7916writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
7917@command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
7918PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
7919compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
7920BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
7921
016687f8
AM
7922@kindex --secure-plt
7923@item --secure-plt
7924@command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
7925@samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
7926when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
7927layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
7928style BSS PLT.
7929
2a60a7a8
AM
7930@cindex PowerPC GOT
7931@kindex --sdata-got
7932@item --sdata-got
7933The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
7934sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
7935@code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
7936section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
7937@code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
7938@code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
7939@samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
7940@code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
7941PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
7942pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
7943GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
7944really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
7945
7946@cindex PowerPC stub symbols
7947@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7948@item --emit-stub-syms
7949This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7950symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7951
7952@cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
7953@kindex --no-tls-optimize
7954@item --no-tls-optimize
7955PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7956sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7957disable the optimization.
7958@end table
7959
7960@ifclear GENERIC
7961@lowersections
7962@end ifclear
7963@end ifset
7964
7965@ifset POWERPC64
7966@ifclear GENERIC
7967@raisesections
7968@end ifclear
7969
7970@node PowerPC64 ELF64
7971@section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7972
7973@cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
7974@table @option
7975@cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
7976@kindex --stub-group-size
7977@item --stub-group-size
7978Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
7979by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7980@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7981sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7982a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7983the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7984conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7985prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7986A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7987branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7988@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7989@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7990detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7991positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7992
7993Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7994single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7995create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7996large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7997
7998@cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
7999@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8000@item --emit-stub-syms
8001This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8002symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8003
8004@cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
8005@kindex --dotsyms
8006@kindex --no-dotsyms
95421fb9
AM
8007@item --dotsyms
8008@itemx --no-dotsyms
2a60a7a8
AM
8009These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
8010in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
8011function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
8012code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
8013properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
8014to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
8015@samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
8016dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
8017feature.
8018
7ae4ea7d
AM
8019@cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
8020@kindex --save-restore-funcs
8021@kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
95421fb9
AM
8022@item --save-restore-funcs
8023@itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
7ae4ea7d
AM
8024These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
8025provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
8026@samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
8027function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
8028link.
8029
2a60a7a8
AM
8030@cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
8031@kindex --no-tls-optimize
8032@item --no-tls-optimize
8033PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8034sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8035disable the optimization.
8036
7c9cf415
AM
8037@cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
8038@kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
8039@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa
AM
8040@kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
8041@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
95421fb9
AM
8042@item --tls-get-addr-optimize
8043@itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa 8044These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
7c9cf415
AM
8045stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
8046an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
8047@code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
9e7028aa
AM
8048stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
8049generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
8050__tls_get_addr_opt.
8051Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
8052much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
8053an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
8054will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
8055@option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
8056and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
8057this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
8058Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
5cebc931 8059@option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
9e7028aa 8060register saves.
7c9cf415 8061
2a60a7a8
AM
8062@cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
8063@kindex --no-opd-optimize
8064@item --no-opd-optimize
8065PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
8066corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
e7fc76dd 8067the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
2a60a7a8
AM
8068Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
8069
8070@cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
8071@kindex --non-overlapping-opd
8072@item --non-overlapping-opd
8073Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
8074@code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
8075the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
8076entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
8077
8078@cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
8079@kindex --no-toc-optimize
8080@item --no-toc-optimize
8081PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
8082entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
8083reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
8084marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
8085marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
8086relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
8087unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
8088reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
8089discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
8090reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
8091code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
8092optimization.
8093
d882c988
AM
8094@cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
8095@kindex --no-inline-optimize
8096@item --no-inline-optimize
8097PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
8098marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
8099@code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
8100a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
8101locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
8102disables that optimization.
8103
2a60a7a8
AM
8104@cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
8105@kindex --no-multi-toc
8106@item --no-multi-toc
794e51c0
AM
8107If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
8108@code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
8109where TOC
2a60a7a8
AM
8110entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
8111total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
8112grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
8113TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
8114calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
8115help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
811664K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
8117Use this option to turn off this feature.
794e51c0
AM
8118
8119@cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
8120@kindex --no-toc-sort
8121@item --no-toc-sort
8122By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
8123happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
8124placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
8125with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
8126referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
8127@code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
8128results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
8129off this feature.
8130
8131@cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
8132@kindex --plt-align
8133@kindex --no-plt-align
8134@item --plt-align
8135@itemx --no-plt-align
8136Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
2420fff6
AM
8137aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
8138boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
8139specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
8140specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
8141if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
8142PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
794e51c0
AM
8143
8144@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
8145@kindex --plt-static-chain
8146@kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8147@item --plt-static-chain
8148@itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8149Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8150chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8151chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8152
8153@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8154@kindex --plt-thread-safe
8155@kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8156@item --plt-thread-safe
1be5d8d3 8157@itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
794e51c0
AM
8158With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8159lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8160another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8161order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8162memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8163barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8164looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8165seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8166default behaviour.
8b5f1ed8
AM
8167
8168@cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8169@kindex --plt-localentry
8170@kindex --no-plt-localentry
8171@item --plt-localentry
8172@itemx --no-localentry
8173ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8174ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8175(the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8176Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8177or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8178functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8179in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
d44c746a
AM
8180interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8181including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8182to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8183complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8184care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
d882c988
AM
8185
8186@cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8187@kindex --power10-stubs
8188@kindex --no-power10-stubs
8189@item --power10-stubs
8190@itemx --no-power10-stubs
8191When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8192relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
e10a07b3
AM
8193linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8194for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8195power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
d882c988
AM
8196power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8197allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
e10a07b3
AM
8198@option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8199auto mode.
2a60a7a8
AM
8200@end table
8201
8202@ifclear GENERIC
8203@lowersections
8204@end ifclear
8205@end ifset
8206
b4cbbe8f
AK
8207@ifset S/390
8208@ifclear GENERIC
8209@raisesections
8210@end ifclear
8211
8212@node S/390 ELF
8213@section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8214
8215@cindex S/390 ELF options
8216@table @option
8217
8218@cindex S/390
8219@kindex --s390-pgste
8220@item --s390-pgste
8221This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8222segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8223binaries marked that way.
8224@end table
8225
8226@ifclear GENERIC
8227@lowersections
8228@end ifclear
8229@end ifset
8230
49fa1e15
AM
8231@ifset SPU
8232@ifclear GENERIC
8233@raisesections
8234@end ifclear
8235
8236@node SPU ELF
8237@section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8238
8239@cindex SPU ELF options
8240@table @option
8241
8242@cindex SPU plugins
8243@kindex --plugin
8244@item --plugin
8245This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8246
8247@cindex SPU overlays
8248@kindex --no-overlays
8249@item --no-overlays
8250Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8251regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8252@command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8253turns off all this special overlay handling.
8254
8255@cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8256@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8257@item --emit-stub-syms
8258This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8259symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8260
8261@cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8262@kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8263@item --extra-overlay-stubs
8264This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8265function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8266on calls to non-overlay regions.
8267
8268@cindex SPU local store size
8269@kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8270@item --local-store=lo:hi
8271@command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8272the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8273range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8274
c0065db7 8275@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8276@kindex --stack-analysis
8277@item --stack-analysis
8278SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8279unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8280under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8281@command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8282@command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8283determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8284for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8285for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8286for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8287find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8288and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8289under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8290dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8291is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8292and calls will be given.
8293
c0065db7 8294@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8295@kindex --emit-stack-syms
8296@item --emit-stack-syms
8297This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8298in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8299These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8300functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8301functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8302such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8303The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
c0065db7 8304@code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
49fa1e15
AM
8305@end table
8306
8307@ifclear GENERIC
8308@lowersections
8309@end ifclear
8310@end ifset
8311
36f63dca
NC
8312@ifset TICOFF
8313@ifclear GENERIC
8314@raisesections
8315@end ifclear
8316
8317@node TI COFF
8318@section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8319@cindex TI COFF versions
8320@kindex --format=@var{version}
8321The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8322TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8323also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8324format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8325header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8326
8327@ifclear GENERIC
8328@lowersections
8329@end ifclear
8330@end ifset
8331
2ca22b03
NC
8332@ifset WIN32
8333@ifclear GENERIC
8334@raisesections
8335@end ifclear
8336
8337@node WIN32
8338@section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8339
c0065db7 8340This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
a05a5b64
TP
8341See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8342command-line options mentioned here.
2ca22b03
NC
8343
8344@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8345@cindex import libraries
8346@item import libraries
69da35b5 8347The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
2ca22b03 8348libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
69da35b5
NC
8349regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8350archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
2ca22b03 8351support for creating such libraries provided with the
a05a5b64 8352@samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
2ca22b03 8353
c0065db7
RM
8354@item exporting DLL symbols
8355@cindex exporting DLL symbols
dc8465bf
NC
8356The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8357
8358@table @emph
8359@item using auto-export functionality
8360@cindex using auto-export functionality
8361By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
a05a5b64 8362which is controlled by the following command-line options:
dc8465bf 8363
0a5d968e
NC
8364@itemize
8365@item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8366@item --exclude-symbols
8367@item --exclude-libs
e1c37eb5 8368@item --exclude-modules-for-implib
09e2aba4 8369@item --version-script
0a5d968e
NC
8370@end itemize
8371
09e2aba4
DK
8372When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8373(global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8374symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8375often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8376private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
9d5777a3 8377options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
09e2aba4
DK
8378exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8379final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8380
8381If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
0a5d968e
NC
8382command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8383if either of the following are true:
8384
8385@itemize
8386@item A DEF file is used.
8387@item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8388@end itemize
dc8465bf 8389
c0065db7
RM
8390@item using a DEF file
8391@cindex using a DEF file
dc8465bf
NC
8392Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8393an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8394exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8395name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
0a5d968e 8396command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
dc8465bf
NC
8397
8398@example
8399gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8400@end example
8401
0a5d968e
NC
8402Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8403@samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8404
dc8465bf
NC
8405Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8406
8407@example
4b5bd4e7 8408LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
dc8465bf
NC
8409
8410EXPORTS
8411foo
8412bar
8413_bar = bar
4b5bd4e7
DS
8414another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8415var1 DATA
7fcab871
KT
8416doo = foo == foo2
8417eoo DATA == var1
c0065db7 8418@end example
dc8465bf 8419
7fcab871 8420This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
4b5bd4e7
DS
8421symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8422alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8423by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8424@code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
7fcab871
KT
8425@code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8426export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8427in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8428symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
4b5bd4e7 8429
6b31ad16
DS
8430The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8431name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8432the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8433
b45619c0
NC
8434When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8435library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
6b31ad16 8436@code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
c0065db7 8437executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
6b31ad16
DS
8438
8439With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8440specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
c0065db7 8441non-default base address for the image.
6b31ad16
DS
8442
8443If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
a2877985
DS
8444or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8445filename specified on the command line.
6b31ad16 8446
4b5bd4e7
DS
8447The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8448
8449@example
8450EXPORTS
8451 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8452 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
7fcab871 8453 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
c0065db7 8454@end example
4b5bd4e7
DS
8455
8456Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8457@samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8458@samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8459@samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8460Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
7fcab871
KT
8461@samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8462string in import/export table for the symbol.
4b5bd4e7
DS
8463
8464The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8465
8466@code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8467will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8468by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8469linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8470library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8471
8472@code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8473The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8474the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8475@code{*_imp__foo}).
8476
8477@code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8478well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8479read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8480variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8481the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8482extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8483application will behave unexpectedly.
8484
8485@code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8486it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8487symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
de194d85 8488API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
4b5bd4e7 8489the DLL without an import library.
c0065db7 8490
4b5bd4e7
DS
8491See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8492other DEF file statements
dc8465bf
NC
8493
8494@cindex creating a DEF file
8495While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
a05a5b64 8496with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
0a5d968e
NC
8497
8498@item Using decorations
8499@cindex Using decorations
8500Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8501itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8502declared as:
8503
8504@example
8505__declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8506__declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8507@end example
8508
8509All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8510any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8511this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8512the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8513
8514Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
c0065db7 8515decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
0a5d968e
NC
8516instead:
8517
8518@example
8519__declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8520__declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8521@end example
8522
c0065db7
RM
8523This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8524when included by the library itself the header must declare the
0a5d968e
NC
8525variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8526code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
c0065db7 8527of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
0a5d968e
NC
8528omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8529@samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
b45619c0 8530information.
c0065db7 8531@end table
dc8465bf 8532
2ca22b03
NC
8533@cindex automatic data imports
8534@item automatic data imports
8535The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
69da35b5 8536by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
2ca22b03 8537compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
c0065db7 8538issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
69da35b5 8539code to these platforms, especially for large
2ca22b03 8540c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
c0065db7 8541initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
b45619c0 8542decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
c0065db7 8543platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
69da35b5
NC
8544command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8545The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8546suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8547trigger the feature's use.
8548
c0065db7 8549auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
69da35b5
NC
8550additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8551
c0065db7 8552"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
69da35b5
NC
8553documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8554
c0065db7
RM
8555The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8556occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8557One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
69da35b5
NC
8558below.
8559
8560@cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
c0065db7
RM
8561For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8562object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8563offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8564field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8565in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
69da35b5 8566without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
c0065db7 8567The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
69da35b5
NC
8568references.
8569
c0065db7
RM
8570The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8571be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8572themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8573runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8574compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8575support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
69da35b5
NC
8576run without error on an older system.
8577
c0065db7
RM
8578@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8579enabled as needed.
2ca22b03
NC
8580
8581@cindex direct linking to a dll
8582@item direct linking to a dll
8583The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8584including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
69da35b5 8585libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
b45619c0 8586traditional import library method, especially when linking large
c0065db7
RM
8587libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8588function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8589though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
69da35b5 8590storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
c0065db7 8591tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
69da35b5
NC
8592large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8593
c0065db7 8594Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
69da35b5 8595@samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
c0065db7 8596of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
69da35b5
NC
8597perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8598select the dll instead of an import library.
8599
2ca22b03 8600
69da35b5
NC
8601For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8602to find, in the first directory of its search path,
2ca22b03
NC
8603
8604@example
45e948fe
NC
8605libxxx.dll.a
8606xxx.dll.a
8607libxxx.a
8608xxx.lib
f6c4d4b1 8609libxxx.lib
69da35b5 8610cygxxx.dll (*)
45e948fe
NC
8611libxxx.dll
8612xxx.dll
2ca22b03
NC
8613@end example
8614
69da35b5
NC
8615before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8616
c0065db7
RM
8617(*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8618where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8619@samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8620file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
69da35b5
NC
8621@samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8622
c0065db7
RM
8623Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8624@samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
69da35b5
NC
8625was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8626various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8627could coexist on the same machine.
8628
2ca22b03
NC
8629The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8630applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
69da35b5 8631libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
2ca22b03
NC
8632
8633@example
8634bin/
8635 cygxxx.dll
8636lib/
8637 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
c0065db7 8638 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
2ca22b03
NC
8639@end example
8640
c0065db7
RM
8641Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8642done two ways:
2ca22b03
NC
8643
86441. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8645@example
8646gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8647@end example
2ca22b03 8648
69da35b5
NC
8649However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8650(@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8651@samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8652not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8653
2ca22b03
NC
86542. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8655directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8656should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8657making the app/dll.
8658
8659@example
8660ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
c0065db7 8661@end example
2ca22b03
NC
8662
8663Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8664
8665@example
8666gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8667@end example
69da35b5
NC
8668
8669This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8670perfectly legal
8671
8672@example
8673bin/
8674 cygxxx-5.dll
8675lib/
c0065db7 8676 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
69da35b5
NC
8677@end example
8678
dc8465bf 8679Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
69da35b5
NC
8680even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8681@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8682
8683Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
45e948fe 8684wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
69da35b5
NC
8685
86861. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8687work with auto-imported data.
8688
dc8465bf
NC
86892. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8690import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8691symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8692for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8693possible to do this without an import lib.
69da35b5 8694
45e948fe
NC
86953. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8696critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8697in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8698stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8699
69da35b5 8700So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
c0065db7
RM
8701true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8702a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8703binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
69da35b5
NC
8704massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8705requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8706will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
dc8465bf 8707
c0065db7 8708@item symbol aliasing
dc8465bf 8709@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8710@item adding additional names
8711Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
dc8465bf
NC
8712A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8713exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8714when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
c0065db7 8715import library. Consider the following DEF file:
dc8465bf 8716
c0065db7 8717@example
dc8465bf
NC
8718LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8719
8720EXPORTS
c0065db7 8721foo
dc8465bf 8722_foo = foo
c0065db7 8723@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8724
8725The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8726
8727Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8728source code using the "weak" attribute:
8729
c0065db7
RM
8730@example
8731void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
dc8465bf 8732void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
c0065db7 8733@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8734
8735See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8736symbols.
8737
8738@item renaming symbols
8739Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
c0065db7 8740kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
dc8465bf
NC
8741@samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8742DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
c0065db7 8743created). In the following example:
dc8465bf 8744
c0065db7 8745@example
dc8465bf
NC
8746LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8747
8748EXPORTS
8749_foo = foo
c0065db7 8750@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8751
8752The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8753@samp{_foo}.
c0065db7 8754@end table
dc8465bf 8755
0a5d968e 8756Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
a05a5b64 8757unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
0a5d968e 8758If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
c0065db7
RM
8759@emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8760that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8761@samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8762renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8763to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8764the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8765In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
0a5d968e 8766which is probably not what you wanted.
c87db184
CF
8767
8768@cindex weak externals
8769@item weak externals
8770The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8771weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8772defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8773are three variants of weak externals:
8774@itemize
8775@item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8776called lazy externals.
8777@item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8778This form is not presently implemented.
8779@item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8780implemented.
8781@end itemize
8782As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8783are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8784uses a default value.
c1711530
DK
8785
8786@cindex aligned common symbols
8787@item aligned common symbols
8788As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8789desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8790the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8791carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8792by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8793tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8794but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8795warnings about unknown linker directives.
5063daf7 8796
2ca22b03
NC
8797@end table
8798
8799@ifclear GENERIC
8800@lowersections
8801@end ifclear
8802@end ifset
8803
e0001a05
NC
8804@ifset XTENSA
8805@ifclear GENERIC
8806@raisesections
8807@end ifclear
8808
8809@node Xtensa
8810@section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8811
8812@cindex Xtensa processors
8813The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8814@code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8815specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8816keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
8817example, with the command:
8818
8819@smallexample
8820SECTIONS
8821@{
8822 .text : @{
8823 *(.literal .text)
8824 @}
8825@}
8826@end smallexample
8827
8828@noindent
8829@command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8830and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8831literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
8832interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8833group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8834files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8835and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
e0001a05 8836
43cd72b9 8837@cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
e0001a05 8838@cindex relaxing on Xtensa
43cd72b9
BW
8839Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8840provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
8841is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
8842literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8843will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
8844location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
8845the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
8846unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
8847@code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
8848range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
8849
8850For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
8851to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
8852instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
8853instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
8854instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
8855@code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
8856hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
8857By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
8858switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
8859density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
8860instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
8861performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
8862linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
8863a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
8864
8865The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
8866control the linker:
8867
8868@cindex Xtensa options
8869@table @option
43cd72b9
BW
8870@item --size-opt
8871When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
8872more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
8873no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
8874alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
8875preserve the correctness of the code.
7a77f1ac
MF
8876
8877@item --abi-windowed
8878@itemx --abi-call0
8879Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
8880PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
8881because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
8882conventions.
8883Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
8884of the first input object.
8885A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
8886or the chosen output object ABI.
43cd72b9 8887@end table
e0001a05
NC
8888
8889@ifclear GENERIC
8890@lowersections
8891@end ifclear
8892@end ifset
8893
252b5132
RH
8894@ifclear SingleFormat
8895@node BFD
8896@chapter BFD
8897
8898@cindex back end
8899@cindex object file management
8900@cindex object formats available
8901@kindex objdump -i
8902The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
8903These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
8904object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
8905format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
8906it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
8907associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
8908object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
8909(@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
8910list all the formats available for your configuration.
8911
8912@cindex BFD requirements
8913@cindex requirements for BFD
8914As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
8915several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
8916BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
8917formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
8918been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
8919BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
8920may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
8921
8922One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
8923mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
8924useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
8925conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
8926
8927@menu
8928* BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
8929@end menu
8930
8931@node BFD outline
36f63dca 8932@section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
252b5132
RH
8933@cindex opening object files
8934@include bfdsumm.texi
8935@end ifclear
8936
8937@node Reporting Bugs
8938@chapter Reporting Bugs
ff5dcc92
SC
8939@cindex bugs in @command{ld}
8940@cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
252b5132 8941
ff5dcc92 8942Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
252b5132
RH
8943
8944Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
8945it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
ff5dcc92 8946to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
252b5132 8947work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
ff5dcc92 8948@command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
8949
8950In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
8951information that enables us to fix the bug.
8952
8953@menu
8954* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
8955* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
8956@end menu
8957
8958@node Bug Criteria
36f63dca 8959@section Have You Found a Bug?
252b5132
RH
8960@cindex bug criteria
8961
8962If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
8963
8964@itemize @bullet
8965@cindex fatal signal
8966@cindex linker crash
8967@cindex crash of linker
8968@item
8969If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
ff5dcc92 8970@command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
252b5132
RH
8971
8972@cindex error on valid input
8973@item
ff5dcc92 8974If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
252b5132
RH
8975
8976@cindex invalid input
8977@item
ff5dcc92 8978If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
252b5132
RH
8979may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
8980object files are correct.
8981
8982@item
8983If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
ff5dcc92 8984improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
252b5132
RH
8985@end itemize
8986
8987@node Bug Reporting
36f63dca 8988@section How to Report Bugs
252b5132 8989@cindex bug reports
ff5dcc92 8990@cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
252b5132
RH
8991
8992A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
ff5dcc92 8993products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
252b5132
RH
8994recommend you contact that organization first.
8995
8996You can find contact information for many support companies and
8997individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
8998distribution.
8999
ad22bfe8 9000@ifset BUGURL
ff5dcc92 9001Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
ad22bfe8
JM
9002@value{BUGURL}.
9003@end ifset
252b5132
RH
9004
9005The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
9006@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
9007fact or leave it out, state it!
9008
9009Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
9010problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
b553b183
NC
9011assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
9012matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
9013the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
9014location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
9015were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
9016into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
9017specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
c0065db7 9018and the most helpful.
b553b183
NC
9019
9020Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
9021the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
9022on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
252b5132
RH
9023
9024Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
36f63dca
NC
9025bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
9026respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
9027You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
252b5132
RH
9028
9029To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
9030
9031@itemize @bullet
9032@item
ff5dcc92 9033The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
252b5132
RH
9034the @samp{--version} argument.
9035
9036Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
ff5dcc92 9037the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
9038
9039@item
ff5dcc92 9040Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
252b5132
RH
9041patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
9042
9043@item
9044The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
9045version number.
9046
9047@item
ff5dcc92 9048What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
252b5132
RH
9049``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
9050
9051@item
9052The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
9053observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
9054list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
9055sufficient.
9056
9057If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
9058and then we might not encounter the bug.
9059
9060@item
9061A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
b553b183
NC
9062bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
9063provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
9064bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
9065state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
9066requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
9067we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
9068attachments are best.
252b5132
RH
9069
9070If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
9071@code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
9072object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
9073@code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
9074how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
9075
9076@item
9077A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
9078incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
9079
ff5dcc92 9080Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
252b5132
RH
9081will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
9082not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
9083a chance to make a mistake.
9084
9085Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
9086say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
b45619c0 9087copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
252b5132
RH
9088C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
9089and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
9090fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
9091you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
9092any conclusion from our observations.
9093
9094@item
ff5dcc92 9095If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
252b5132
RH
9096diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
9097@samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
ff5dcc92 9098If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
252b5132
RH
9099context, not by line number.
9100
9101The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
9102sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
9103@end itemize
9104
9105Here are some things that are not necessary:
9106
9107@itemize @bullet
9108@item
9109A description of the envelope of the bug.
9110
9111Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
9112which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
9113changes will not affect it.
9114
9115This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
9116will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
9117with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
9118We recommend that you save your time for something else.
9119
9120Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
9121of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
9122output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
9123less time, and so on.
9124
9125However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
9126report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
9127
9128@item
9129A patch for the bug.
9130
9131A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
9132the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
9133a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
9134to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
9135
ff5dcc92 9136Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
252b5132
RH
9137construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
9138through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
9139able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
9140fixed.
9141
9142And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
9143patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
9144help us to understand.
9145
9146@item
9147A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9148
9149Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
9150things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9151@end itemize
9152
9153@node MRI
9154@appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9155@cindex MRI compatibility
ff5dcc92
SC
9156To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9157linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
252b5132
RH
9158alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9159described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9160simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
ff5dcc92 9161@command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
252b5132
RH
9162linker commands; these commands are described here.
9163
9164In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9165file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9166features to make use of them.
9167
9168You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9169@samp{-c} command-line option.
9170
9171Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9172command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9173blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
ff5dcc92 9174MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9175issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9176
9177Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9178
9179You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9180lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9181The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9182
9183@table @code
9184@cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9185@item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9186@itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9187Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
252b5132
RH
9188the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9189@code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9190your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9191script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9192commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9193input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9194@code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9195
9196@cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9197@item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9198Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9199in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9200
9201@var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9202
9203@cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9204@item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9205Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9206@var{expression} should be a power of two.
9207
9208@cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9209@item BASE @var{expression}
9210Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9211absolute addresses) in the output file.
9212
9213@cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9214@item CHIP @var{expression}
9215@itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9216This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9217
9218@cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9219@item END
9220This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9221
9222@cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9223@item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9224Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
dc12032b 9225language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
252b5132
RH
9226
9227@cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9228@item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9229Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
ff5dcc92 9230@command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
252b5132
RH
9231
9232The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9233same line, with no change in its effect.
9234
9235@cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9236@item LOAD @var{filename}
9237@itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9238Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
ff5dcc92 9239same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9240command line.
9241
9242@cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9243@item NAME @var{output-name}
ff5dcc92 9244@var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
252b5132
RH
9245MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9246option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9247
9248@cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9249@item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9250@itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9251Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
252b5132
RH
9252order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9253script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9254sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9255file, in the order specified.
9256
9257@cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9258@item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9259@itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9260@itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9261Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9262@var{name} used in the linker input files.
9263
9264@cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9265@item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9266@itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9267@itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9268You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9269specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9270If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9271@var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9272@end table
9273
793c5807
NC
9274@node GNU Free Documentation License
9275@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
36f63dca 9276@include fdl.texi
704c465c 9277
370b66a1
CD
9278@node LD Index
9279@unnumbered LD Index
252b5132
RH
9280
9281@printindex cp
9282
9283@tex
7ca01ed9 9284% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
252b5132
RH
9285% meantime:
9286\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9287\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9288\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9289\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9290\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9291\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9292\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9293\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9294\page\colophon
7ca01ed9 9295% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
252b5132
RH
9296@end tex
9297
252b5132 9298@bye
This page took 1.836906 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.